+ */
+
+/* Define to prevent recursive inclusion -------------------------------------*/
+#ifndef __STM32F10x_FSMC_H
+#define __STM32F10x_FSMC_H
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+ extern "C" {
+#endif
+
+/* Includes ------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+#include "stm32f10x.h"
+
+/** @addtogroup STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/** @addtogroup FSMC
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Exported_Types
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @brief Timing parameters For NOR/SRAM Banks
+ */
+
+typedef struct
+{
+ uint32_t FSMC_AddressSetupTime; /*!< Defines the number of HCLK cycles to configure
+ the duration of the address setup time.
+ This parameter can be a value between 0 and 0xF.
+ @note: It is not used with synchronous NOR Flash memories. */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_AddressHoldTime; /*!< Defines the number of HCLK cycles to configure
+ the duration of the address hold time.
+ This parameter can be a value between 0 and 0xF.
+ @note: It is not used with synchronous NOR Flash memories.*/
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_DataSetupTime; /*!< Defines the number of HCLK cycles to configure
+ the duration of the data setup time.
+ This parameter can be a value between 0 and 0xFF.
+ @note: It is used for SRAMs, ROMs and asynchronous multiplexed NOR Flash memories. */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_BusTurnAroundDuration; /*!< Defines the number of HCLK cycles to configure
+ the duration of the bus turnaround.
+ This parameter can be a value between 0 and 0xF.
+ @note: It is only used for multiplexed NOR Flash memories. */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_CLKDivision; /*!< Defines the period of CLK clock output signal, expressed in number of HCLK cycles.
+ This parameter can be a value between 1 and 0xF.
+ @note: This parameter is not used for asynchronous NOR Flash, SRAM or ROM accesses. */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_DataLatency; /*!< Defines the number of memory clock cycles to issue
+ to the memory before getting the first data.
+ The value of this parameter depends on the memory type as shown below:
+ - It must be set to 0 in case of a CRAM
+ - It is don’t care in asynchronous NOR, SRAM or ROM accesses
+ - It may assume a value between 0 and 0xF in NOR Flash memories
+ with synchronous burst mode enable */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_AccessMode; /*!< Specifies the asynchronous access mode.
+ This parameter can be a value of @ref FSMC_Access_Mode */
+}FSMC_NORSRAMTimingInitTypeDef;
+
+/**
+ * @brief FSMC NOR/SRAM Init structure definition
+ */
+
+typedef struct
+{
+ uint32_t FSMC_Bank; /*!< Specifies the NOR/SRAM memory bank that will be used.
+ This parameter can be a value of @ref FSMC_NORSRAM_Bank */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_DataAddressMux; /*!< Specifies whether the address and data values are
+ multiplexed on the databus or not.
+ This parameter can be a value of @ref FSMC_Data_Address_Bus_Multiplexing */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_MemoryType; /*!< Specifies the type of external memory attached to
+ the corresponding memory bank.
+ This parameter can be a value of @ref FSMC_Memory_Type */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_MemoryDataWidth; /*!< Specifies the external memory device width.
+ This parameter can be a value of @ref FSMC_Data_Width */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_BurstAccessMode; /*!< Enables or disables the burst access mode for Flash memory,
+ valid only with synchronous burst Flash memories.
+ This parameter can be a value of @ref FSMC_Burst_Access_Mode */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_AsynchronousWait; /*!< Enables or disables wait signal during asynchronous transfers,
+ valid only with asynchronous Flash memories.
+ This parameter can be a value of @ref FSMC_AsynchronousWait */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_WaitSignalPolarity; /*!< Specifies the wait signal polarity, valid only when accessing
+ the Flash memory in burst mode.
+ This parameter can be a value of @ref FSMC_Wait_Signal_Polarity */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_WrapMode; /*!< Enables or disables the Wrapped burst access mode for Flash
+ memory, valid only when accessing Flash memories in burst mode.
+ This parameter can be a value of @ref FSMC_Wrap_Mode */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_WaitSignalActive; /*!< Specifies if the wait signal is asserted by the memory one
+ clock cycle before the wait state or during the wait state,
+ valid only when accessing memories in burst mode.
+ This parameter can be a value of @ref FSMC_Wait_Timing */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_WriteOperation; /*!< Enables or disables the write operation in the selected bank by the FSMC.
+ This parameter can be a value of @ref FSMC_Write_Operation */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_WaitSignal; /*!< Enables or disables the wait-state insertion via wait
+ signal, valid for Flash memory access in burst mode.
+ This parameter can be a value of @ref FSMC_Wait_Signal */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_ExtendedMode; /*!< Enables or disables the extended mode.
+ This parameter can be a value of @ref FSMC_Extended_Mode */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_WriteBurst; /*!< Enables or disables the write burst operation.
+ This parameter can be a value of @ref FSMC_Write_Burst */
+
+ FSMC_NORSRAMTimingInitTypeDef* FSMC_ReadWriteTimingStruct; /*!< Timing Parameters for write and read access if the ExtendedMode is not used*/
+
+ FSMC_NORSRAMTimingInitTypeDef* FSMC_WriteTimingStruct; /*!< Timing Parameters for write access if the ExtendedMode is used*/
+}FSMC_NORSRAMInitTypeDef;
+
+/**
+ * @brief Timing parameters For FSMC NAND and PCCARD Banks
+ */
+
+typedef struct
+{
+ uint32_t FSMC_SetupTime; /*!< Defines the number of HCLK cycles to setup address before
+ the command assertion for NAND-Flash read or write access
+ to common/Attribute or I/O memory space (depending on
+ the memory space timing to be configured).
+ This parameter can be a value between 0 and 0xFF.*/
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_WaitSetupTime; /*!< Defines the minimum number of HCLK cycles to assert the
+ command for NAND-Flash read or write access to
+ common/Attribute or I/O memory space (depending on the
+ memory space timing to be configured).
+ This parameter can be a number between 0x00 and 0xFF */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_HoldSetupTime; /*!< Defines the number of HCLK clock cycles to hold address
+ (and data for write access) after the command deassertion
+ for NAND-Flash read or write access to common/Attribute
+ or I/O memory space (depending on the memory space timing
+ to be configured).
+ This parameter can be a number between 0x00 and 0xFF */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_HiZSetupTime; /*!< Defines the number of HCLK clock cycles during which the
+ databus is kept in HiZ after the start of a NAND-Flash
+ write access to common/Attribute or I/O memory space (depending
+ on the memory space timing to be configured).
+ This parameter can be a number between 0x00 and 0xFF */
+}FSMC_NAND_PCCARDTimingInitTypeDef;
+
+/**
+ * @brief FSMC NAND Init structure definition
+ */
+
+typedef struct
+{
+ uint32_t FSMC_Bank; /*!< Specifies the NAND memory bank that will be used.
+ This parameter can be a value of @ref FSMC_NAND_Bank */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_Waitfeature; /*!< Enables or disables the Wait feature for the NAND Memory Bank.
+ This parameter can be any value of @ref FSMC_Wait_feature */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_MemoryDataWidth; /*!< Specifies the external memory device width.
+ This parameter can be any value of @ref FSMC_Data_Width */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_ECC; /*!< Enables or disables the ECC computation.
+ This parameter can be any value of @ref FSMC_ECC */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_ECCPageSize; /*!< Defines the page size for the extended ECC.
+ This parameter can be any value of @ref FSMC_ECC_Page_Size */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_TCLRSetupTime; /*!< Defines the number of HCLK cycles to configure the
+ delay between CLE low and RE low.
+ This parameter can be a value between 0 and 0xFF. */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_TARSetupTime; /*!< Defines the number of HCLK cycles to configure the
+ delay between ALE low and RE low.
+ This parameter can be a number between 0x0 and 0xFF */
+
+ FSMC_NAND_PCCARDTimingInitTypeDef* FSMC_CommonSpaceTimingStruct; /*!< FSMC Common Space Timing */
+
+ FSMC_NAND_PCCARDTimingInitTypeDef* FSMC_AttributeSpaceTimingStruct; /*!< FSMC Attribute Space Timing */
+}FSMC_NANDInitTypeDef;
+
+/**
+ * @brief FSMC PCCARD Init structure definition
+ */
+
+typedef struct
+{
+ uint32_t FSMC_Waitfeature; /*!< Enables or disables the Wait feature for the Memory Bank.
+ This parameter can be any value of @ref FSMC_Wait_feature */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_TCLRSetupTime; /*!< Defines the number of HCLK cycles to configure the
+ delay between CLE low and RE low.
+ This parameter can be a value between 0 and 0xFF. */
+
+ uint32_t FSMC_TARSetupTime; /*!< Defines the number of HCLK cycles to configure the
+ delay between ALE low and RE low.
+ This parameter can be a number between 0x0 and 0xFF */
+
+
+ FSMC_NAND_PCCARDTimingInitTypeDef* FSMC_CommonSpaceTimingStruct; /*!< FSMC Common Space Timing */
+
+ FSMC_NAND_PCCARDTimingInitTypeDef* FSMC_AttributeSpaceTimingStruct; /*!< FSMC Attribute Space Timing */
+
+ FSMC_NAND_PCCARDTimingInitTypeDef* FSMC_IOSpaceTimingStruct; /*!< FSMC IO Space Timing */
+}FSMC_PCCARDInitTypeDef;
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Exported_Constants
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_NORSRAM_Bank
+ * @{
+ */
+#define FSMC_Bank1_NORSRAM1 ((uint32_t)0x00000000)
+#define FSMC_Bank1_NORSRAM2 ((uint32_t)0x00000002)
+#define FSMC_Bank1_NORSRAM3 ((uint32_t)0x00000004)
+#define FSMC_Bank1_NORSRAM4 ((uint32_t)0x00000006)
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_NAND_Bank
+ * @{
+ */
+#define FSMC_Bank2_NAND ((uint32_t)0x00000010)
+#define FSMC_Bank3_NAND ((uint32_t)0x00000100)
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_PCCARD_Bank
+ * @{
+ */
+#define FSMC_Bank4_PCCARD ((uint32_t)0x00001000)
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+#define IS_FSMC_NORSRAM_BANK(BANK) (((BANK) == FSMC_Bank1_NORSRAM1) || \
+ ((BANK) == FSMC_Bank1_NORSRAM2) || \
+ ((BANK) == FSMC_Bank1_NORSRAM3) || \
+ ((BANK) == FSMC_Bank1_NORSRAM4))
+
+#define IS_FSMC_NAND_BANK(BANK) (((BANK) == FSMC_Bank2_NAND) || \
+ ((BANK) == FSMC_Bank3_NAND))
+
+#define IS_FSMC_GETFLAG_BANK(BANK) (((BANK) == FSMC_Bank2_NAND) || \
+ ((BANK) == FSMC_Bank3_NAND) || \
+ ((BANK) == FSMC_Bank4_PCCARD))
+
+#define IS_FSMC_IT_BANK(BANK) (((BANK) == FSMC_Bank2_NAND) || \
+ ((BANK) == FSMC_Bank3_NAND) || \
+ ((BANK) == FSMC_Bank4_PCCARD))
+
+/** @defgroup NOR_SRAM_Controller
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Data_Address_Bus_Multiplexing
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define FSMC_DataAddressMux_Disable ((uint32_t)0x00000000)
+#define FSMC_DataAddressMux_Enable ((uint32_t)0x00000002)
+#define IS_FSMC_MUX(MUX) (((MUX) == FSMC_DataAddressMux_Disable) || \
+ ((MUX) == FSMC_DataAddressMux_Enable))
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Memory_Type
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define FSMC_MemoryType_SRAM ((uint32_t)0x00000000)
+#define FSMC_MemoryType_PSRAM ((uint32_t)0x00000004)
+#define FSMC_MemoryType_NOR ((uint32_t)0x00000008)
+#define IS_FSMC_MEMORY(MEMORY) (((MEMORY) == FSMC_MemoryType_SRAM) || \
+ ((MEMORY) == FSMC_MemoryType_PSRAM)|| \
+ ((MEMORY) == FSMC_MemoryType_NOR))
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Data_Width
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define FSMC_MemoryDataWidth_8b ((uint32_t)0x00000000)
+#define FSMC_MemoryDataWidth_16b ((uint32_t)0x00000010)
+#define IS_FSMC_MEMORY_WIDTH(WIDTH) (((WIDTH) == FSMC_MemoryDataWidth_8b) || \
+ ((WIDTH) == FSMC_MemoryDataWidth_16b))
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Burst_Access_Mode
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define FSMC_BurstAccessMode_Disable ((uint32_t)0x00000000)
+#define FSMC_BurstAccessMode_Enable ((uint32_t)0x00000100)
+#define IS_FSMC_BURSTMODE(STATE) (((STATE) == FSMC_BurstAccessMode_Disable) || \
+ ((STATE) == FSMC_BurstAccessMode_Enable))
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_AsynchronousWait
+ * @{
+ */
+#define FSMC_AsynchronousWait_Disable ((uint32_t)0x00000000)
+#define FSMC_AsynchronousWait_Enable ((uint32_t)0x00008000)
+#define IS_FSMC_ASYNWAIT(STATE) (((STATE) == FSMC_AsynchronousWait_Disable) || \
+ ((STATE) == FSMC_AsynchronousWait_Enable))
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Wait_Signal_Polarity
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define FSMC_WaitSignalPolarity_Low ((uint32_t)0x00000000)
+#define FSMC_WaitSignalPolarity_High ((uint32_t)0x00000200)
+#define IS_FSMC_WAIT_POLARITY(POLARITY) (((POLARITY) == FSMC_WaitSignalPolarity_Low) || \
+ ((POLARITY) == FSMC_WaitSignalPolarity_High))
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Wrap_Mode
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define FSMC_WrapMode_Disable ((uint32_t)0x00000000)
+#define FSMC_WrapMode_Enable ((uint32_t)0x00000400)
+#define IS_FSMC_WRAP_MODE(MODE) (((MODE) == FSMC_WrapMode_Disable) || \
+ ((MODE) == FSMC_WrapMode_Enable))
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Wait_Timing
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define FSMC_WaitSignalActive_BeforeWaitState ((uint32_t)0x00000000)
+#define FSMC_WaitSignalActive_DuringWaitState ((uint32_t)0x00000800)
+#define IS_FSMC_WAIT_SIGNAL_ACTIVE(ACTIVE) (((ACTIVE) == FSMC_WaitSignalActive_BeforeWaitState) || \
+ ((ACTIVE) == FSMC_WaitSignalActive_DuringWaitState))
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Write_Operation
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define FSMC_WriteOperation_Disable ((uint32_t)0x00000000)
+#define FSMC_WriteOperation_Enable ((uint32_t)0x00001000)
+#define IS_FSMC_WRITE_OPERATION(OPERATION) (((OPERATION) == FSMC_WriteOperation_Disable) || \
+ ((OPERATION) == FSMC_WriteOperation_Enable))
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Wait_Signal
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define FSMC_WaitSignal_Disable ((uint32_t)0x00000000)
+#define FSMC_WaitSignal_Enable ((uint32_t)0x00002000)
+#define IS_FSMC_WAITE_SIGNAL(SIGNAL) (((SIGNAL) == FSMC_WaitSignal_Disable) || \
+ ((SIGNAL) == FSMC_WaitSignal_Enable))
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Extended_Mode
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define FSMC_ExtendedMode_Disable ((uint32_t)0x00000000)
+#define FSMC_ExtendedMode_Enable ((uint32_t)0x00004000)
+
+#define IS_FSMC_EXTENDED_MODE(MODE) (((MODE) == FSMC_ExtendedMode_Disable) || \
+ ((MODE) == FSMC_ExtendedMode_Enable))
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Write_Burst
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define FSMC_WriteBurst_Disable ((uint32_t)0x00000000)
+#define FSMC_WriteBurst_Enable ((uint32_t)0x00080000)
+#define IS_FSMC_WRITE_BURST(BURST) (((BURST) == FSMC_WriteBurst_Disable) || \
+ ((BURST) == FSMC_WriteBurst_Enable))
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Address_Setup_Time
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define IS_FSMC_ADDRESS_SETUP_TIME(TIME) ((TIME) <= 0xF)
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Address_Hold_Time
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define IS_FSMC_ADDRESS_HOLD_TIME(TIME) ((TIME) <= 0xF)
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Data_Setup_Time
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define IS_FSMC_DATASETUP_TIME(TIME) (((TIME) > 0) && ((TIME) <= 0xFF))
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Bus_Turn_around_Duration
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define IS_FSMC_TURNAROUND_TIME(TIME) ((TIME) <= 0xF)
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_CLK_Division
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define IS_FSMC_CLK_DIV(DIV) ((DIV) <= 0xF)
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Data_Latency
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define IS_FSMC_DATA_LATENCY(LATENCY) ((LATENCY) <= 0xF)
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Access_Mode
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define FSMC_AccessMode_A ((uint32_t)0x00000000)
+#define FSMC_AccessMode_B ((uint32_t)0x10000000)
+#define FSMC_AccessMode_C ((uint32_t)0x20000000)
+#define FSMC_AccessMode_D ((uint32_t)0x30000000)
+#define IS_FSMC_ACCESS_MODE(MODE) (((MODE) == FSMC_AccessMode_A) || \
+ ((MODE) == FSMC_AccessMode_B) || \
+ ((MODE) == FSMC_AccessMode_C) || \
+ ((MODE) == FSMC_AccessMode_D))
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup NAND_PCCARD_Controller
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Wait_feature
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define FSMC_Waitfeature_Disable ((uint32_t)0x00000000)
+#define FSMC_Waitfeature_Enable ((uint32_t)0x00000002)
+#define IS_FSMC_WAIT_FEATURE(FEATURE) (((FEATURE) == FSMC_Waitfeature_Disable) || \
+ ((FEATURE) == FSMC_Waitfeature_Enable))
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_ECC
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define FSMC_ECC_Disable ((uint32_t)0x00000000)
+#define FSMC_ECC_Enable ((uint32_t)0x00000040)
+#define IS_FSMC_ECC_STATE(STATE) (((STATE) == FSMC_ECC_Disable) || \
+ ((STATE) == FSMC_ECC_Enable))
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_ECC_Page_Size
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define FSMC_ECCPageSize_256Bytes ((uint32_t)0x00000000)
+#define FSMC_ECCPageSize_512Bytes ((uint32_t)0x00020000)
+#define FSMC_ECCPageSize_1024Bytes ((uint32_t)0x00040000)
+#define FSMC_ECCPageSize_2048Bytes ((uint32_t)0x00060000)
+#define FSMC_ECCPageSize_4096Bytes ((uint32_t)0x00080000)
+#define FSMC_ECCPageSize_8192Bytes ((uint32_t)0x000A0000)
+#define IS_FSMC_ECCPAGE_SIZE(SIZE) (((SIZE) == FSMC_ECCPageSize_256Bytes) || \
+ ((SIZE) == FSMC_ECCPageSize_512Bytes) || \
+ ((SIZE) == FSMC_ECCPageSize_1024Bytes) || \
+ ((SIZE) == FSMC_ECCPageSize_2048Bytes) || \
+ ((SIZE) == FSMC_ECCPageSize_4096Bytes) || \
+ ((SIZE) == FSMC_ECCPageSize_8192Bytes))
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_TCLR_Setup_Time
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define IS_FSMC_TCLR_TIME(TIME) ((TIME) <= 0xFF)
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_TAR_Setup_Time
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define IS_FSMC_TAR_TIME(TIME) ((TIME) <= 0xFF)
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Setup_Time
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define IS_FSMC_SETUP_TIME(TIME) ((TIME) <= 0xFF)
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Wait_Setup_Time
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define IS_FSMC_WAIT_TIME(TIME) ((TIME) <= 0xFF)
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Hold_Setup_Time
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define IS_FSMC_HOLD_TIME(TIME) ((TIME) <= 0xFF)
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_HiZ_Setup_Time
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define IS_FSMC_HIZ_TIME(TIME) ((TIME) <= 0xFF)
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Interrupt_sources
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define FSMC_IT_RisingEdge ((uint32_t)0x00000008)
+#define FSMC_IT_Level ((uint32_t)0x00000010)
+#define FSMC_IT_FallingEdge ((uint32_t)0x00000020)
+#define IS_FSMC_IT(IT) ((((IT) & (uint32_t)0xFFFFFFC7) == 0x00000000) && ((IT) != 0x00000000))
+#define IS_FSMC_GET_IT(IT) (((IT) == FSMC_IT_RisingEdge) || \
+ ((IT) == FSMC_IT_Level) || \
+ ((IT) == FSMC_IT_FallingEdge))
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Flags
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define FSMC_FLAG_RisingEdge ((uint32_t)0x00000001)
+#define FSMC_FLAG_Level ((uint32_t)0x00000002)
+#define FSMC_FLAG_FallingEdge ((uint32_t)0x00000004)
+#define FSMC_FLAG_FEMPT ((uint32_t)0x00000040)
+#define IS_FSMC_GET_FLAG(FLAG) (((FLAG) == FSMC_FLAG_RisingEdge) || \
+ ((FLAG) == FSMC_FLAG_Level) || \
+ ((FLAG) == FSMC_FLAG_FallingEdge) || \
+ ((FLAG) == FSMC_FLAG_FEMPT))
+
+#define IS_FSMC_CLEAR_FLAG(FLAG) ((((FLAG) & (uint32_t)0xFFFFFFF8) == 0x00000000) && ((FLAG) != 0x00000000))
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Exported_Macros
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FSMC_Exported_Functions
+ * @{
+ */
+
+void FSMC_NORSRAMDeInit(uint32_t FSMC_Bank);
+void FSMC_NANDDeInit(uint32_t FSMC_Bank);
+void FSMC_PCCARDDeInit(void);
+void FSMC_NORSRAMInit(FSMC_NORSRAMInitTypeDef* FSMC_NORSRAMInitStruct);
+void FSMC_NANDInit(FSMC_NANDInitTypeDef* FSMC_NANDInitStruct);
+void FSMC_PCCARDInit(FSMC_PCCARDInitTypeDef* FSMC_PCCARDInitStruct);
+void FSMC_NORSRAMStructInit(FSMC_NORSRAMInitTypeDef* FSMC_NORSRAMInitStruct);
+void FSMC_NANDStructInit(FSMC_NANDInitTypeDef* FSMC_NANDInitStruct);
+void FSMC_PCCARDStructInit(FSMC_PCCARDInitTypeDef* FSMC_PCCARDInitStruct);
+void FSMC_NORSRAMCmd(uint32_t FSMC_Bank, FunctionalState NewState);
+void FSMC_NANDCmd(uint32_t FSMC_Bank, FunctionalState NewState);
+void FSMC_PCCARDCmd(FunctionalState NewState);
+void FSMC_NANDECCCmd(uint32_t FSMC_Bank, FunctionalState NewState);
+uint32_t FSMC_GetECC(uint32_t FSMC_Bank);
+void FSMC_ITConfig(uint32_t FSMC_Bank, uint32_t FSMC_IT, FunctionalState NewState);
+FlagStatus FSMC_GetFlagStatus(uint32_t FSMC_Bank, uint32_t FSMC_FLAG);
+void FSMC_ClearFlag(uint32_t FSMC_Bank, uint32_t FSMC_FLAG);
+ITStatus FSMC_GetITStatus(uint32_t FSMC_Bank, uint32_t FSMC_IT);
+void FSMC_ClearITPendingBit(uint32_t FSMC_Bank, uint32_t FSMC_IT);
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+}
+#endif
+
+#endif /*__STM32F10x_FSMC_H */
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/******************* (C) COPYRIGHT 2010 STMicroelectronics *****END OF FILE****/
diff --git a/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Libraries/STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver/inc/stm32f10x_gpio.h b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Libraries/STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver/inc/stm32f10x_gpio.h
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..1d99df02e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Libraries/STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver/inc/stm32f10x_gpio.h
@@ -0,0 +1,384 @@
+/**
+ ******************************************************************************
+ * @file stm32f10x_gpio.h
+ * @author MCD Application Team
+ * @version V3.4.0
+ * @date 10/15/2010
+ * @brief This file contains all the functions prototypes for the GPIO
+ * firmware library.
+ ******************************************************************************
+ * @copy
+ *
+ * THE PRESENT FIRMWARE WHICH IS FOR GUIDANCE ONLY AIMS AT PROVIDING CUSTOMERS
+ * WITH CODING INFORMATION REGARDING THEIR PRODUCTS IN ORDER FOR THEM TO SAVE
+ * TIME. AS A RESULT, STMICROELECTRONICS SHALL NOT BE HELD LIABLE FOR ANY
+ * DIRECT, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES WITH RESPECT TO ANY CLAIMS ARISING
+ * FROM THE CONTENT OF SUCH FIRMWARE AND/OR THE USE MADE BY CUSTOMERS OF THE
+ * CODING INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN IN CONNECTION WITH THEIR PRODUCTS.
+ *
+ *
+ */
+
+/* Define to prevent recursive inclusion -------------------------------------*/
+#ifndef __STM32F10x_I2C_H
+#define __STM32F10x_I2C_H
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+ extern "C" {
+#endif
+
+/* Includes ------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+#include "stm32f10x.h"
+
+/** @addtogroup STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/** @addtogroup I2C
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_Exported_Types
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @brief I2C Init structure definition
+ */
+
+typedef struct
+{
+ uint32_t I2C_ClockSpeed; /*!< Specifies the clock frequency.
+ This parameter must be set to a value lower than 400kHz */
+
+ uint16_t I2C_Mode; /*!< Specifies the I2C mode.
+ This parameter can be a value of @ref I2C_mode */
+
+ uint16_t I2C_DutyCycle; /*!< Specifies the I2C fast mode duty cycle.
+ This parameter can be a value of @ref I2C_duty_cycle_in_fast_mode */
+
+ uint16_t I2C_OwnAddress1; /*!< Specifies the first device own address.
+ This parameter can be a 7-bit or 10-bit address. */
+
+ uint16_t I2C_Ack; /*!< Enables or disables the acknowledgement.
+ This parameter can be a value of @ref I2C_acknowledgement */
+
+ uint16_t I2C_AcknowledgedAddress; /*!< Specifies if 7-bit or 10-bit address is acknowledged.
+ This parameter can be a value of @ref I2C_acknowledged_address */
+}I2C_InitTypeDef;
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_Exported_Constants
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(PERIPH) (((PERIPH) == I2C1) || \
+ ((PERIPH) == I2C2))
+/** @defgroup I2C_mode
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define I2C_Mode_I2C ((uint16_t)0x0000)
+#define I2C_Mode_SMBusDevice ((uint16_t)0x0002)
+#define I2C_Mode_SMBusHost ((uint16_t)0x000A)
+#define IS_I2C_MODE(MODE) (((MODE) == I2C_Mode_I2C) || \
+ ((MODE) == I2C_Mode_SMBusDevice) || \
+ ((MODE) == I2C_Mode_SMBusHost))
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_duty_cycle_in_fast_mode
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define I2C_DutyCycle_16_9 ((uint16_t)0x4000) /*!< I2C fast mode Tlow/Thigh = 16/9 */
+#define I2C_DutyCycle_2 ((uint16_t)0xBFFF) /*!< I2C fast mode Tlow/Thigh = 2 */
+#define IS_I2C_DUTY_CYCLE(CYCLE) (((CYCLE) == I2C_DutyCycle_16_9) || \
+ ((CYCLE) == I2C_DutyCycle_2))
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_acknowledgement
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define I2C_Ack_Enable ((uint16_t)0x0400)
+#define I2C_Ack_Disable ((uint16_t)0x0000)
+#define IS_I2C_ACK_STATE(STATE) (((STATE) == I2C_Ack_Enable) || \
+ ((STATE) == I2C_Ack_Disable))
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_transfer_direction
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define I2C_Direction_Transmitter ((uint8_t)0x00)
+#define I2C_Direction_Receiver ((uint8_t)0x01)
+#define IS_I2C_DIRECTION(DIRECTION) (((DIRECTION) == I2C_Direction_Transmitter) || \
+ ((DIRECTION) == I2C_Direction_Receiver))
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_acknowledged_address
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define I2C_AcknowledgedAddress_7bit ((uint16_t)0x4000)
+#define I2C_AcknowledgedAddress_10bit ((uint16_t)0xC000)
+#define IS_I2C_ACKNOWLEDGE_ADDRESS(ADDRESS) (((ADDRESS) == I2C_AcknowledgedAddress_7bit) || \
+ ((ADDRESS) == I2C_AcknowledgedAddress_10bit))
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_registers
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define I2C_Register_CR1 ((uint8_t)0x00)
+#define I2C_Register_CR2 ((uint8_t)0x04)
+#define I2C_Register_OAR1 ((uint8_t)0x08)
+#define I2C_Register_OAR2 ((uint8_t)0x0C)
+#define I2C_Register_DR ((uint8_t)0x10)
+#define I2C_Register_SR1 ((uint8_t)0x14)
+#define I2C_Register_SR2 ((uint8_t)0x18)
+#define I2C_Register_CCR ((uint8_t)0x1C)
+#define I2C_Register_TRISE ((uint8_t)0x20)
+#define IS_I2C_REGISTER(REGISTER) (((REGISTER) == I2C_Register_CR1) || \
+ ((REGISTER) == I2C_Register_CR2) || \
+ ((REGISTER) == I2C_Register_OAR1) || \
+ ((REGISTER) == I2C_Register_OAR2) || \
+ ((REGISTER) == I2C_Register_DR) || \
+ ((REGISTER) == I2C_Register_SR1) || \
+ ((REGISTER) == I2C_Register_SR2) || \
+ ((REGISTER) == I2C_Register_CCR) || \
+ ((REGISTER) == I2C_Register_TRISE))
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_SMBus_alert_pin_level
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define I2C_SMBusAlert_Low ((uint16_t)0x2000)
+#define I2C_SMBusAlert_High ((uint16_t)0xDFFF)
+#define IS_I2C_SMBUS_ALERT(ALERT) (((ALERT) == I2C_SMBusAlert_Low) || \
+ ((ALERT) == I2C_SMBusAlert_High))
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_PEC_position
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define I2C_PECPosition_Next ((uint16_t)0x0800)
+#define I2C_PECPosition_Current ((uint16_t)0xF7FF)
+#define IS_I2C_PEC_POSITION(POSITION) (((POSITION) == I2C_PECPosition_Next) || \
+ ((POSITION) == I2C_PECPosition_Current))
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_interrupts_definition
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define I2C_IT_BUF ((uint16_t)0x0400)
+#define I2C_IT_EVT ((uint16_t)0x0200)
+#define I2C_IT_ERR ((uint16_t)0x0100)
+#define IS_I2C_CONFIG_IT(IT) ((((IT) & (uint16_t)0xF8FF) == 0x00) && ((IT) != 0x00))
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_interrupts_definition
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define I2C_IT_SMBALERT ((uint32_t)0x01008000)
+#define I2C_IT_TIMEOUT ((uint32_t)0x01004000)
+#define I2C_IT_PECERR ((uint32_t)0x01001000)
+#define I2C_IT_OVR ((uint32_t)0x01000800)
+#define I2C_IT_AF ((uint32_t)0x01000400)
+#define I2C_IT_ARLO ((uint32_t)0x01000200)
+#define I2C_IT_BERR ((uint32_t)0x01000100)
+#define I2C_IT_TXE ((uint32_t)0x06000080)
+#define I2C_IT_RXNE ((uint32_t)0x06000040)
+#define I2C_IT_STOPF ((uint32_t)0x02000010)
+#define I2C_IT_ADD10 ((uint32_t)0x02000008)
+#define I2C_IT_BTF ((uint32_t)0x02000004)
+#define I2C_IT_ADDR ((uint32_t)0x02000002)
+#define I2C_IT_SB ((uint32_t)0x02000001)
+
+#define IS_I2C_CLEAR_IT(IT) ((((IT) & (uint16_t)0x20FF) == 0x00) && ((IT) != (uint16_t)0x00))
+
+#define IS_I2C_GET_IT(IT) (((IT) == I2C_IT_SMBALERT) || ((IT) == I2C_IT_TIMEOUT) || \
+ ((IT) == I2C_IT_PECERR) || ((IT) == I2C_IT_OVR) || \
+ ((IT) == I2C_IT_AF) || ((IT) == I2C_IT_ARLO) || \
+ ((IT) == I2C_IT_BERR) || ((IT) == I2C_IT_TXE) || \
+ ((IT) == I2C_IT_RXNE) || ((IT) == I2C_IT_STOPF) || \
+ ((IT) == I2C_IT_ADD10) || ((IT) == I2C_IT_BTF) || \
+ ((IT) == I2C_IT_ADDR) || ((IT) == I2C_IT_SB))
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_flags_definition
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @brief SR2 register flags
+ */
+
+#define I2C_FLAG_DUALF ((uint32_t)0x00800000)
+#define I2C_FLAG_SMBHOST ((uint32_t)0x00400000)
+#define I2C_FLAG_SMBDEFAULT ((uint32_t)0x00200000)
+#define I2C_FLAG_GENCALL ((uint32_t)0x00100000)
+#define I2C_FLAG_TRA ((uint32_t)0x00040000)
+#define I2C_FLAG_BUSY ((uint32_t)0x00020000)
+#define I2C_FLAG_MSL ((uint32_t)0x00010000)
+
+/**
+ * @brief SR1 register flags
+ */
+
+#define I2C_FLAG_SMBALERT ((uint32_t)0x10008000)
+#define I2C_FLAG_TIMEOUT ((uint32_t)0x10004000)
+#define I2C_FLAG_PECERR ((uint32_t)0x10001000)
+#define I2C_FLAG_OVR ((uint32_t)0x10000800)
+#define I2C_FLAG_AF ((uint32_t)0x10000400)
+#define I2C_FLAG_ARLO ((uint32_t)0x10000200)
+#define I2C_FLAG_BERR ((uint32_t)0x10000100)
+#define I2C_FLAG_TXE ((uint32_t)0x10000080)
+#define I2C_FLAG_RXNE ((uint32_t)0x10000040)
+#define I2C_FLAG_STOPF ((uint32_t)0x10000010)
+#define I2C_FLAG_ADD10 ((uint32_t)0x10000008)
+#define I2C_FLAG_BTF ((uint32_t)0x10000004)
+#define I2C_FLAG_ADDR ((uint32_t)0x10000002)
+#define I2C_FLAG_SB ((uint32_t)0x10000001)
+
+#define IS_I2C_CLEAR_FLAG(FLAG) ((((FLAG) & (uint16_t)0x20FF) == 0x00) && ((FLAG) != (uint16_t)0x00))
+
+#define IS_I2C_GET_FLAG(FLAG) (((FLAG) == I2C_FLAG_DUALF) || ((FLAG) == I2C_FLAG_SMBHOST) || \
+ ((FLAG) == I2C_FLAG_SMBDEFAULT) || ((FLAG) == I2C_FLAG_GENCALL) || \
+ ((FLAG) == I2C_FLAG_TRA) || ((FLAG) == I2C_FLAG_BUSY) || \
+ ((FLAG) == I2C_FLAG_MSL) || ((FLAG) == I2C_FLAG_SMBALERT) || \
+ ((FLAG) == I2C_FLAG_TIMEOUT) || ((FLAG) == I2C_FLAG_PECERR) || \
+ ((FLAG) == I2C_FLAG_OVR) || ((FLAG) == I2C_FLAG_AF) || \
+ ((FLAG) == I2C_FLAG_ARLO) || ((FLAG) == I2C_FLAG_BERR) || \
+ ((FLAG) == I2C_FLAG_TXE) || ((FLAG) == I2C_FLAG_RXNE) || \
+ ((FLAG) == I2C_FLAG_STOPF) || ((FLAG) == I2C_FLAG_ADD10) || \
+ ((FLAG) == I2C_FLAG_BTF) || ((FLAG) == I2C_FLAG_ADDR) || \
+ ((FLAG) == I2C_FLAG_SB))
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_Events
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/*========================================
+
+ I2C Master Events (Events grouped in order of communication)
+ ==========================================*/
+/**
+ * @brief Communication start
+ *
+ * After sending the START condition (I2C_GenerateSTART() function) the master
+ * has to wait for this event. It means that the Start condition has been correctly
+ * released on the I2C bus (the bus is free, no other devices is communicating).
+ *
+ */
+/* --EV5 */
+#define I2C_EVENT_MASTER_MODE_SELECT ((uint32_t)0x00030001) /* BUSY, MSL and SB flag */
+
+/**
+ * @brief Address Acknowledge
+ *
+ * After checking on EV5 (start condition correctly released on the bus), the
+ * master sends the address of the slave(s) with which it will communicate
+ * (I2C_Send7bitAddress() function, it also determines the direction of the communication:
+ * Master transmitter or Receiver). Then the master has to wait that a slave acknowledges
+ * his address. If an acknowledge is sent on the bus, one of the following events will
+ * be set:
+ *
+ * 1) In case of Master Receiver (7-bit addressing): the I2C_EVENT_MASTER_RECEIVER_MODE_SELECTED
+ * event is set.
+ *
+ * 2) In case of Master Transmitter (7-bit addressing): the I2C_EVENT_MASTER_TRANSMITTER_MODE_SELECTED
+ * is set
+ *
+ * 3) In case of 10-Bit addressing mode, the master (just after generating the START
+ * and checking on EV5) has to send the header of 10-bit addressing mode (I2C_SendData()
+ * function). Then master should wait on EV9. It means that the 10-bit addressing
+ * header has been correctly sent on the bus. Then master should send the second part of
+ * the 10-bit address (LSB) using the function I2C_Send7bitAddress(). Then master
+ * should wait for event EV6.
+ *
+ */
+
+/* --EV6 */
+#define I2C_EVENT_MASTER_TRANSMITTER_MODE_SELECTED ((uint32_t)0x00070082) /* BUSY, MSL, ADDR, TXE and TRA flags */
+#define I2C_EVENT_MASTER_RECEIVER_MODE_SELECTED ((uint32_t)0x00030002) /* BUSY, MSL and ADDR flags */
+/* --EV9 */
+#define I2C_EVENT_MASTER_MODE_ADDRESS10 ((uint32_t)0x00030008) /* BUSY, MSL and ADD10 flags */
+
+/**
+ * @brief Communication events
+ *
+ * If a communication is established (START condition generated and slave address
+ * acknowledged) then the master has to check on one of the following events for
+ * communication procedures:
+ *
+ * 1) Master Receiver mode: The master has to wait on the event EV7 then to read
+ * the data received from the slave (I2C_ReceiveData() function).
+ *
+ * 2) Master Transmitter mode: The master has to send data (I2C_SendData()
+ * function) then to wait on event EV8 or EV8_2.
+ * These two events are similar:
+ * - EV8 means that the data has been written in the data register and is
+ * being shifted out.
+ * - EV8_2 means that the data has been physically shifted out and output
+ * on the bus.
+ * In most cases, using EV8 is sufficient for the application.
+ * Using EV8_2 leads to a slower communication but ensure more reliable test.
+ * EV8_2 is also more suitable than EV8 for testing on the last data transmission
+ * (before Stop condition generation).
+ *
+ * @note In case the user software does not guarantee that this event EV7 is
+ * managed before the current byte end of transfer, then user may check on EV7
+ * and BTF flag at the same time (ie. (I2C_EVENT_MASTER_BYTE_RECEIVED | I2C_FLAG_BTF)).
+ * In this case the communication may be slower.
+ *
+ */
+
+/* Master RECEIVER mode -----------------------------*/
+/* --EV7 */
+#define I2C_EVENT_MASTER_BYTE_RECEIVED ((uint32_t)0x00030040) /* BUSY, MSL and RXNE flags */
+
+/* Master TRANSMITTER mode --------------------------*/
+/* --EV8 */
+#define I2C_EVENT_MASTER_BYTE_TRANSMITTING ((uint32_t)0x00070080) /* TRA, BUSY, MSL, TXE flags */
+/* --EV8_2 */
+#define I2C_EVENT_MASTER_BYTE_TRANSMITTED ((uint32_t)0x00070084) /* TRA, BUSY, MSL, TXE and BTF flags */
+
+
+/*========================================
+
+ I2C Slave Events (Events grouped in order of communication)
+ ==========================================*/
+
+/**
+ * @brief Communication start events
+ *
+ * Wait on one of these events at the start of the communication. It means that
+ * the I2C peripheral detected a Start condition on the bus (generated by master
+ * device) followed by the peripheral address. The peripheral generates an ACK
+ * condition on the bus (if the acknowledge feature is enabled through function
+ * I2C_AcknowledgeConfig()) and the events listed above are set :
+ *
+ * 1) In normal case (only one address managed by the slave), when the address
+ * sent by the master matches the own address of the peripheral (configured by
+ * I2C_OwnAddress1 field) the I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_XXX_ADDRESS_MATCHED event is set
+ * (where XXX could be TRANSMITTER or RECEIVER).
+ *
+ * 2) In case the address sent by the master matches the second address of the
+ * peripheral (configured by the function I2C_OwnAddress2Config() and enabled
+ * by the function I2C_DualAddressCmd()) the events I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_XXX_SECONDADDRESS_MATCHED
+ * (where XXX could be TRANSMITTER or RECEIVER) are set.
+ *
+ * 3) In case the address sent by the master is General Call (address 0x00) and
+ * if the General Call is enabled for the peripheral (using function I2C_GeneralCallCmd())
+ * the following event is set I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_GENERALCALLADDRESS_MATCHED.
+ *
+ */
+
+/* --EV1 (all the events below are variants of EV1) */
+/* 1) Case of One Single Address managed by the slave */
+#define I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_RECEIVER_ADDRESS_MATCHED ((uint32_t)0x00020002) /* BUSY and ADDR flags */
+#define I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_TRANSMITTER_ADDRESS_MATCHED ((uint32_t)0x00060082) /* TRA, BUSY, TXE and ADDR flags */
+
+/* 2) Case of Dual address managed by the slave */
+#define I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_RECEIVER_SECONDADDRESS_MATCHED ((uint32_t)0x00820000) /* DUALF and BUSY flags */
+#define I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_TRANSMITTER_SECONDADDRESS_MATCHED ((uint32_t)0x00860080) /* DUALF, TRA, BUSY and TXE flags */
+
+/* 3) Case of General Call enabled for the slave */
+#define I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_GENERALCALLADDRESS_MATCHED ((uint32_t)0x00120000) /* GENCALL and BUSY flags */
+
+/**
+ * @brief Communication events
+ *
+ * Wait on one of these events when EV1 has already been checked and:
+ *
+ * - Slave RECEIVER mode:
+ * - EV2: When the application is expecting a data byte to be received.
+ * - EV4: When the application is expecting the end of the communication: master
+ * sends a stop condition and data transmission is stopped.
+ *
+ * - Slave Transmitter mode:
+ * - EV3: When a byte has been transmitted by the slave and the application is expecting
+ * the end of the byte transmission. The two events I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_BYTE_TRANSMITTED and
+ * I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_BYTE_TRANSMITTING are similar. The second one can optionally be
+ * used when the user software doesn't guarantee the EV3 is managed before the
+ * current byte end of tranfer.
+ * - EV3_2: When the master sends a NACK in order to tell slave that data transmission
+ * shall end (before sending the STOP condition). In this case slave has to stop sending
+ * data bytes and expect a Stop condition on the bus.
+ *
+ * @note In case the user software does not guarantee that the event EV2 is
+ * managed before the current byte end of transfer, then user may check on EV2
+ * and BTF flag at the same time (ie. (I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_BYTE_RECEIVED | I2C_FLAG_BTF)).
+ * In this case the communication may be slower.
+ *
+ */
+
+/* Slave RECEIVER mode --------------------------*/
+/* --EV2 */
+#define I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_BYTE_RECEIVED ((uint32_t)0x00020040) /* BUSY and RXNE flags */
+/* --EV4 */
+#define I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_STOP_DETECTED ((uint32_t)0x00000010) /* STOPF flag */
+
+/* Slave TRANSMITTER mode -----------------------*/
+/* --EV3 */
+#define I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_BYTE_TRANSMITTED ((uint32_t)0x00060084) /* TRA, BUSY, TXE and BTF flags */
+#define I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_BYTE_TRANSMITTING ((uint32_t)0x00060080) /* TRA, BUSY and TXE flags */
+/* --EV3_2 */
+#define I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_ACK_FAILURE ((uint32_t)0x00000400) /* AF flag */
+
+/*=========================== End of Events Description ==========================================*/
+
+#define IS_I2C_EVENT(EVENT) (((EVENT) == I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_TRANSMITTER_ADDRESS_MATCHED) || \
+ ((EVENT) == I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_RECEIVER_ADDRESS_MATCHED) || \
+ ((EVENT) == I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_TRANSMITTER_SECONDADDRESS_MATCHED) || \
+ ((EVENT) == I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_RECEIVER_SECONDADDRESS_MATCHED) || \
+ ((EVENT) == I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_GENERALCALLADDRESS_MATCHED) || \
+ ((EVENT) == I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_BYTE_RECEIVED) || \
+ ((EVENT) == (I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_BYTE_RECEIVED | I2C_FLAG_DUALF)) || \
+ ((EVENT) == (I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_BYTE_RECEIVED | I2C_FLAG_GENCALL)) || \
+ ((EVENT) == I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_BYTE_TRANSMITTED) || \
+ ((EVENT) == (I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_BYTE_TRANSMITTED | I2C_FLAG_DUALF)) || \
+ ((EVENT) == (I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_BYTE_TRANSMITTED | I2C_FLAG_GENCALL)) || \
+ ((EVENT) == I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_STOP_DETECTED) || \
+ ((EVENT) == I2C_EVENT_MASTER_MODE_SELECT) || \
+ ((EVENT) == I2C_EVENT_MASTER_TRANSMITTER_MODE_SELECTED) || \
+ ((EVENT) == I2C_EVENT_MASTER_RECEIVER_MODE_SELECTED) || \
+ ((EVENT) == I2C_EVENT_MASTER_BYTE_RECEIVED) || \
+ ((EVENT) == I2C_EVENT_MASTER_BYTE_TRANSMITTED) || \
+ ((EVENT) == I2C_EVENT_MASTER_BYTE_TRANSMITTING) || \
+ ((EVENT) == I2C_EVENT_MASTER_MODE_ADDRESS10) || \
+ ((EVENT) == I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_ACK_FAILURE))
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_own_address1
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define IS_I2C_OWN_ADDRESS1(ADDRESS1) ((ADDRESS1) <= 0x3FF)
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_clock_speed
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define IS_I2C_CLOCK_SPEED(SPEED) (((SPEED) >= 0x1) && ((SPEED) <= 400000))
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_Exported_Macros
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_Exported_Functions
+ * @{
+ */
+
+void I2C_DeInit(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx);
+void I2C_Init(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, I2C_InitTypeDef* I2C_InitStruct);
+void I2C_StructInit(I2C_InitTypeDef* I2C_InitStruct);
+void I2C_Cmd(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState);
+void I2C_DMACmd(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState);
+void I2C_DMALastTransferCmd(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState);
+void I2C_GenerateSTART(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState);
+void I2C_GenerateSTOP(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState);
+void I2C_AcknowledgeConfig(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState);
+void I2C_OwnAddress2Config(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint8_t Address);
+void I2C_DualAddressCmd(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState);
+void I2C_GeneralCallCmd(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState);
+void I2C_ITConfig(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint16_t I2C_IT, FunctionalState NewState);
+void I2C_SendData(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint8_t Data);
+uint8_t I2C_ReceiveData(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx);
+void I2C_Send7bitAddress(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint8_t Address, uint8_t I2C_Direction);
+uint16_t I2C_ReadRegister(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint8_t I2C_Register);
+void I2C_SoftwareResetCmd(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState);
+void I2C_SMBusAlertConfig(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint16_t I2C_SMBusAlert);
+void I2C_TransmitPEC(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState);
+void I2C_PECPositionConfig(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint16_t I2C_PECPosition);
+void I2C_CalculatePEC(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState);
+uint8_t I2C_GetPEC(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx);
+void I2C_ARPCmd(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState);
+void I2C_StretchClockCmd(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState);
+void I2C_FastModeDutyCycleConfig(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint16_t I2C_DutyCycle);
+
+/**
+ * @brief
+ ****************************************************************************************
+ *
+ * I2C State Monitoring Functions
+ *
+ ****************************************************************************************
+ * This I2C driver provides three different ways for I2C state monitoring
+ * depending on the application requirements and constraints:
+ *
+ *
+ * 1) Basic state monitoring:
+ * Using I2C_CheckEvent() function:
+ * It compares the status registers (SR1 and SR2) content to a given event
+ * (can be the combination of one or more flags).
+ * It returns SUCCESS if the current status includes the given flags
+ * and returns ERROR if one or more flags are missing in the current status.
+ * - When to use:
+ * - This function is suitable for most applications as well as for startup
+ * activity since the events are fully described in the product reference manual
+ * (RM0008).
+ * - It is also suitable for users who need to define their own events.
+ * - Limitations:
+ * - If an error occurs (ie. error flags are set besides to the monitored flags),
+ * the I2C_CheckEvent() function may return SUCCESS despite the communication
+ * hold or corrupted real state.
+ * In this case, it is advised to use error interrupts to monitor the error
+ * events and handle them in the interrupt IRQ handler.
+ *
+ * @note
+ * For error management, it is advised to use the following functions:
+ * - I2C_ITConfig() to configure and enable the error interrupts (I2C_IT_ERR).
+ * - I2Cx_ER_IRQHandler() which is called when the error interurpt occurs.
+ * Where x is the peripheral instance (I2C1, I2C2 ...)
+ * - I2C_GetFlagStatus() or I2C_GetITStatus() to be called into I2Cx_ER_IRQHandler()
+ * in order to determine which error occured.
+ * - I2C_ClearFlag() or I2C_ClearITPendingBit() and/or I2C_SoftwareResetCmd()
+ * and/or I2C_GenerateStop() in order to clear the error flag and source,
+ * and return to correct communication status.
+ *
+ *
+ * 2) Advanced state monitoring:
+ * Using the function I2C_GetLastEvent() which returns the image of both status
+ * registers in a single word (uint32_t) (Status Register 2 value is shifted left
+ * by 16 bits and concatenated to Status Register 1).
+ * - When to use:
+ * - This function is suitable for the same applications above but it allows to
+ * overcome the limitations of I2C_GetFlagStatus() function (see below).
+ * The returned value could be compared to events already defined in the
+ * library (stm32f10x_i2c.h) or to custom values defined by user.
+ * - This function is suitable when multiple flags are monitored at the same time.
+ * - At the opposite of I2C_CheckEvent() function, this function allows user to
+ * choose when an event is accepted (when all events flags are set and no
+ * other flags are set or just when the needed flags are set like
+ * I2C_CheckEvent() function).
+ * - Limitations:
+ * - User may need to define his own events.
+ * - Same remark concerning the error management is applicable for this
+ * function if user decides to check only regular communication flags (and
+ * ignores error flags).
+ *
+ *
+ * 3) Flag-based state monitoring:
+ * Using the function I2C_GetFlagStatus() which simply returns the status of
+ * one single flag (ie. I2C_FLAG_RXNE ...).
+ * - When to use:
+ * - This function could be used for specific applications or in debug phase.
+ * - It is suitable when only one flag checking is needed (most I2C events
+ * are monitored through multiple flags).
+ * - Limitations:
+ * - When calling this function, the Status register is accessed. Some flags are
+ * cleared when the status register is accessed. So checking the status
+ * of one Flag, may clear other ones.
+ * - Function may need to be called twice or more in order to monitor one
+ * single event.
+ *
+ */
+
+/**
+ *
+ * 1) Basic state monitoring
+ *******************************************************************************
+ */
+ErrorStatus I2C_CheckEvent(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint32_t I2C_EVENT);
+/**
+ *
+ * 2) Advanced state monitoring
+ *******************************************************************************
+ */
+uint32_t I2C_GetLastEvent(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx);
+/**
+ *
+ * 3) Flag-based state monitoring
+ *******************************************************************************
+ */
+FlagStatus I2C_GetFlagStatus(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint32_t I2C_FLAG);
+/**
+ *
+ *******************************************************************************
+ */
+
+void I2C_ClearFlag(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint32_t I2C_FLAG);
+ITStatus I2C_GetITStatus(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint32_t I2C_IT);
+void I2C_ClearITPendingBit(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint32_t I2C_IT);
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+}
+#endif
+
+#endif /*__STM32F10x_I2C_H */
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/******************* (C) COPYRIGHT 2010 STMicroelectronics *****END OF FILE****/
diff --git a/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Libraries/STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver/inc/stm32f10x_iwdg.h b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Libraries/STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver/inc/stm32f10x_iwdg.h
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..4325ad450
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Libraries/STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver/inc/stm32f10x_iwdg.h
@@ -0,0 +1,139 @@
+/**
+ ******************************************************************************
+ * @file stm32f10x_iwdg.h
+ * @author MCD Application Team
+ * @version V3.4.0
+ * @date 10/15/2010
+ * @brief This file contains all the functions prototypes for the IWDG
+ * firmware library.
+ ******************************************************************************
+ * @copy
+ *
+ * THE PRESENT FIRMWARE WHICH IS FOR GUIDANCE ONLY AIMS AT PROVIDING CUSTOMERS
+ * WITH CODING INFORMATION REGARDING THEIR PRODUCTS IN ORDER FOR THEM TO SAVE
+ * TIME. AS A RESULT, STMICROELECTRONICS SHALL NOT BE HELD LIABLE FOR ANY
+ * DIRECT, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES WITH RESPECT TO ANY CLAIMS ARISING
+ * FROM THE CONTENT OF SUCH FIRMWARE AND/OR THE USE MADE BY CUSTOMERS OF THE
+ * CODING INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN IN CONNECTION WITH THEIR PRODUCTS.
+ *
+ *
+ */
+
+/* Includes ------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+#include "stm32f10x_flash.h"
+
+/** @addtogroup STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FLASH
+ * @brief FLASH driver modules
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FLASH_Private_TypesDefinitions
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FLASH_Private_Defines
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/* Flash Access Control Register bits */
+#define ACR_LATENCY_Mask ((uint32_t)0x00000038)
+#define ACR_HLFCYA_Mask ((uint32_t)0xFFFFFFF7)
+#define ACR_PRFTBE_Mask ((uint32_t)0xFFFFFFEF)
+
+/* Flash Access Control Register bits */
+#define ACR_PRFTBS_Mask ((uint32_t)0x00000020)
+
+/* Flash Control Register bits */
+#define CR_PG_Set ((uint32_t)0x00000001)
+#define CR_PG_Reset ((uint32_t)0x00001FFE)
+#define CR_PER_Set ((uint32_t)0x00000002)
+#define CR_PER_Reset ((uint32_t)0x00001FFD)
+#define CR_MER_Set ((uint32_t)0x00000004)
+#define CR_MER_Reset ((uint32_t)0x00001FFB)
+#define CR_OPTPG_Set ((uint32_t)0x00000010)
+#define CR_OPTPG_Reset ((uint32_t)0x00001FEF)
+#define CR_OPTER_Set ((uint32_t)0x00000020)
+#define CR_OPTER_Reset ((uint32_t)0x00001FDF)
+#define CR_STRT_Set ((uint32_t)0x00000040)
+#define CR_LOCK_Set ((uint32_t)0x00000080)
+
+/* FLASH Mask */
+#define RDPRT_Mask ((uint32_t)0x00000002)
+#define WRP0_Mask ((uint32_t)0x000000FF)
+#define WRP1_Mask ((uint32_t)0x0000FF00)
+#define WRP2_Mask ((uint32_t)0x00FF0000)
+#define WRP3_Mask ((uint32_t)0xFF000000)
+#define OB_USER_BFB2 ((uint16_t)0x0008)
+
+/* FLASH Keys */
+#define RDP_Key ((uint16_t)0x00A5)
+#define FLASH_KEY1 ((uint32_t)0x45670123)
+#define FLASH_KEY2 ((uint32_t)0xCDEF89AB)
+
+/* FLASH BANK address */
+#define FLASH_BANK1_END_ADDRESS ((uint32_t)0x807FFFF)
+
+/* Delay definition */
+#define EraseTimeout ((uint32_t)0x000B0000)
+#define ProgramTimeout ((uint32_t)0x00002000)
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FLASH_Private_Macros
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FLASH_Private_Variables
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FLASH_Private_FunctionPrototypes
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup FLASH_Private_Functions
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+@code
+
+ This driver provides functions to configure and program the Flash memory of all STM32F10x devices,
+ including the latest STM32F10x_XL density devices.
+
+ STM32F10x_XL devices feature up to 1 Mbyte with dual bank architecture for read-while-write (RWW) capability:
+ - bank1: fixed size of 512 Kbytes (256 pages of 2Kbytes each)
+ - bank2: up to 512 Kbytes (up to 256 pages of 2Kbytes each)
+ While other STM32F10x devices features only one bank with memory up to 512 Kbytes.
+
+ In version V3.3.0, some functions were updated and new ones were added to support
+ STM32F10x_XL devices. Thus some functions manages all devices, while other are
+ dedicated for XL devices only.
+
+ The table below presents the list of available functions depending on the used STM32F10x devices.
+
+ ***************************************************
+ * Legacy functions used for all STM32F10x devices *
+ ***************************************************
+ +----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | Functions prototypes |STM32F10x_XL|Other STM32F10x| Comments |
+ | | devices | devices | |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_SetLatency | Yes | Yes | No change |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_HalfCycleAccessCmd | Yes | Yes | No change |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_PrefetchBufferCmd | Yes | Yes | No change |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_Unlock | Yes | Yes | - For STM32F10X_XL devices: unlock Bank1 and Bank2. |
+ | | | | - For other devices: unlock Bank1 and it is equivalent |
+ | | | | to FLASH_UnlockBank1 function. |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_Lock | Yes | Yes | - For STM32F10X_XL devices: lock Bank1 and Bank2. |
+ | | | | - For other devices: lock Bank1 and it is equivalent |
+ | | | | to FLASH_LockBank1 function. |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_ErasePage | Yes | Yes | - For STM32F10x_XL devices: erase a page in Bank1 and Bank2 |
+ | | | | - For other devices: erase a page in Bank1 |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_EraseAllPages | Yes | Yes | - For STM32F10x_XL devices: erase all pages in Bank1 and Bank2 |
+ | | | | - For other devices: erase all pages in Bank1 |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_EraseOptionBytes | Yes | Yes | No change |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_ProgramWord | Yes | Yes | Updated to program up to 1MByte (depending on the used device) |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_ProgramHalfWord | Yes | Yes | Updated to program up to 1MByte (depending on the used device) |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_ProgramOptionByteData | Yes | Yes | No change |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_EnableWriteProtection | Yes | Yes | No change |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_ReadOutProtection | Yes | Yes | No change |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_UserOptionByteConfig | Yes | Yes | No change |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_GetUserOptionByte | Yes | Yes | No change |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_GetWriteProtectionOptionByte | Yes | Yes | No change |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_GetReadOutProtectionStatus | Yes | Yes | No change |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_GetPrefetchBufferStatus | Yes | Yes | No change |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_ITConfig | Yes | Yes | - For STM32F10x_XL devices: enable Bank1 and Bank2's interrupts|
+ | | | | - For other devices: enable Bank1's interrupts |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_GetFlagStatus | Yes | Yes | - For STM32F10x_XL devices: return Bank1 and Bank2's flag status|
+ | | | | - For other devices: return Bank1's flag status |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_ClearFlag | Yes | Yes | - For STM32F10x_XL devices: clear Bank1 and Bank2's flag |
+ | | | | - For other devices: clear Bank1's flag |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_GetStatus | Yes | Yes | - Return the status of Bank1 (for all devices) |
+ | | | | equivalent to FLASH_GetBank1Status function |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_WaitForLastOperation | Yes | Yes | - Wait for Bank1 last operation (for all devices) |
+ | | | | equivalent to: FLASH_WaitForLastBank1Operation function |
+ +----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
+
+ ************************************************************************************************************************
+ * New functions used for all STM32F10x devices to manage Bank1: *
+ * - These functions are mainly useful for STM32F10x_XL density devices, to have separate control for Bank1 and bank2 *
+ * - For other devices, these functions are optional (covered by functions listed above) *
+ ************************************************************************************************************************
+ +----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | Functions prototypes |STM32F10x_XL|Other STM32F10x| Comments |
+ | | devices | devices | |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ | FLASH_UnlockBank1 | Yes | Yes | - Unlock Bank1 |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_LockBank1 | Yes | Yes | - Lock Bank1 |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ | FLASH_EraseAllBank1Pages | Yes | Yes | - Erase all pages in Bank1 |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ | FLASH_GetBank1Status | Yes | Yes | - Return the status of Bank1 |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ | FLASH_WaitForLastBank1Operation | Yes | Yes | - Wait for Bank1 last operation |
+ +----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
+
+ *****************************************************************************
+ * New Functions used only with STM32F10x_XL density devices to manage Bank2 *
+ *****************************************************************************
+ +----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | Functions prototypes |STM32F10x_XL|Other STM32F10x| Comments |
+ | | devices | devices | |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ | FLASH_UnlockBank2 | Yes | No | - Unlock Bank2 |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ |FLASH_LockBank2 | Yes | No | - Lock Bank2 |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ | FLASH_EraseAllBank2Pages | Yes | No | - Erase all pages in Bank2 |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ | FLASH_GetBank2Status | Yes | No | - Return the status of Bank2 |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ | FLASH_WaitForLastBank2Operation | Yes | No | - Wait for Bank2 last operation |
+ |----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------|
+ | FLASH_BootConfig | Yes | No | - Configure to boot from Bank1 or Bank2 |
+ +----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------+
+@endcode
+*/
+
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sets the code latency value.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * @param FLASH_Latency: specifies the FLASH Latency value.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg FLASH_Latency_0: FLASH Zero Latency cycle
+ * @arg FLASH_Latency_1: FLASH One Latency cycle
+ * @arg FLASH_Latency_2: FLASH Two Latency cycles
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void FLASH_SetLatency(uint32_t FLASH_Latency)
+{
+ uint32_t tmpreg = 0;
+
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_FLASH_LATENCY(FLASH_Latency));
+
+ /* Read the ACR register */
+ tmpreg = FLASH->ACR;
+
+ /* Sets the Latency value */
+ tmpreg &= ACR_LATENCY_Mask;
+ tmpreg |= FLASH_Latency;
+
+ /* Write the ACR register */
+ FLASH->ACR = tmpreg;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the Half cycle flash access.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * @param FLASH_HalfCycleAccess: specifies the FLASH Half cycle Access mode.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg FLASH_HalfCycleAccess_Enable: FLASH Half Cycle Enable
+ * @arg FLASH_HalfCycleAccess_Disable: FLASH Half Cycle Disable
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void FLASH_HalfCycleAccessCmd(uint32_t FLASH_HalfCycleAccess)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_FLASH_HALFCYCLEACCESS_STATE(FLASH_HalfCycleAccess));
+
+ /* Enable or disable the Half cycle access */
+ FLASH->ACR &= ACR_HLFCYA_Mask;
+ FLASH->ACR |= FLASH_HalfCycleAccess;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the Prefetch Buffer.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * @param FLASH_PrefetchBuffer: specifies the Prefetch buffer status.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg FLASH_PrefetchBuffer_Enable: FLASH Prefetch Buffer Enable
+ * @arg FLASH_PrefetchBuffer_Disable: FLASH Prefetch Buffer Disable
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void FLASH_PrefetchBufferCmd(uint32_t FLASH_PrefetchBuffer)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_FLASH_PREFETCHBUFFER_STATE(FLASH_PrefetchBuffer));
+
+ /* Enable or disable the Prefetch Buffer */
+ FLASH->ACR &= ACR_PRFTBE_Mask;
+ FLASH->ACR |= FLASH_PrefetchBuffer;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Unlocks the FLASH Program Erase Controller.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * - For STM32F10X_XL devices this function unlocks Bank1 and Bank2.
+ * - For all other devices it unlocks Bank1 and it is equivalent
+ * to FLASH_UnlockBank1 function..
+ * @param None
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void FLASH_Unlock(void)
+{
+ /* Authorize the FPEC of Bank1 Access */
+ FLASH->KEYR = FLASH_KEY1;
+ FLASH->KEYR = FLASH_KEY2;
+
+#ifdef STM32F10X_XL
+ /* Authorize the FPEC of Bank2 Access */
+ FLASH->KEYR2 = FLASH_KEY1;
+ FLASH->KEYR2 = FLASH_KEY2;
+#endif /* STM32F10X_XL */
+}
+/**
+ * @brief Unlocks the FLASH Bank1 Program Erase Controller.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * - For STM32F10X_XL devices this function unlocks Bank1.
+ * - For all other devices it unlocks Bank1 and it is
+ * equivalent to FLASH_Unlock function.
+ * @param None
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void FLASH_UnlockBank1(void)
+{
+ /* Authorize the FPEC of Bank1 Access */
+ FLASH->KEYR = FLASH_KEY1;
+ FLASH->KEYR = FLASH_KEY2;
+}
+
+#ifdef STM32F10X_XL
+/**
+ * @brief Unlocks the FLASH Bank2 Program Erase Controller.
+ * @note This function can be used only for STM32F10X_XL density devices.
+ * @param None
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void FLASH_UnlockBank2(void)
+{
+ /* Authorize the FPEC of Bank2 Access */
+ FLASH->KEYR2 = FLASH_KEY1;
+ FLASH->KEYR2 = FLASH_KEY2;
+
+}
+#endif /* STM32F10X_XL */
+
+/**
+ * @brief Locks the FLASH Program Erase Controller.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * - For STM32F10X_XL devices this function Locks Bank1 and Bank2.
+ * - For all other devices it Locks Bank1 and it is equivalent
+ * to FLASH_LockBank1 function.
+ * @param None
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void FLASH_Lock(void)
+{
+ /* Set the Lock Bit to lock the FPEC and the CR of Bank1 */
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_LOCK_Set;
+
+#ifdef STM32F10X_XL
+ /* Set the Lock Bit to lock the FPEC and the CR of Bank2 */
+ FLASH->CR2 |= CR_LOCK_Set;
+#endif /* STM32F10X_XL */
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Locks the FLASH Bank1 Program Erase Controller.
+ * @note this function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * - For STM32F10X_XL devices this function Locks Bank1.
+ * - For all other devices it Locks Bank1 and it is equivalent
+ * to FLASH_Lock function.
+ * @param None
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void FLASH_LockBank1(void)
+{
+ /* Set the Lock Bit to lock the FPEC and the CR of Bank1 */
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_LOCK_Set;
+}
+
+#ifdef STM32F10X_XL
+/**
+ * @brief Locks the FLASH Bank2 Program Erase Controller.
+ * @note This function can be used only for STM32F10X_XL density devices.
+ * @param None
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void FLASH_LockBank2(void)
+{
+ /* Set the Lock Bit to lock the FPEC and the CR of Bank2 */
+ FLASH->CR2 |= CR_LOCK_Set;
+}
+#endif /* STM32F10X_XL */
+
+/**
+ * @brief Erases a specified FLASH page.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * @param Page_Address: The page address to be erased.
+ * @retval FLASH Status: The returned value can be: FLASH_BUSY, FLASH_ERROR_PG,
+ * FLASH_ERROR_WRP, FLASH_COMPLETE or FLASH_TIMEOUT.
+ */
+FLASH_Status FLASH_ErasePage(uint32_t Page_Address)
+{
+ FLASH_Status status = FLASH_COMPLETE;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_FLASH_ADDRESS(Page_Address));
+
+#ifdef STM32F10X_XL
+ if(Page_Address < FLASH_BANK1_END_ADDRESS)
+ {
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastBank1Operation(EraseTimeout);
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* if the previous operation is completed, proceed to erase the page */
+ FLASH->CR|= CR_PER_Set;
+ FLASH->AR = Page_Address;
+ FLASH->CR|= CR_STRT_Set;
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastBank1Operation(EraseTimeout);
+
+ /* Disable the PER Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_PER_Reset;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastBank2Operation(EraseTimeout);
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* if the previous operation is completed, proceed to erase the page */
+ FLASH->CR2|= CR_PER_Set;
+ FLASH->AR2 = Page_Address;
+ FLASH->CR2|= CR_STRT_Set;
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastBank2Operation(EraseTimeout);
+
+ /* Disable the PER Bit */
+ FLASH->CR2 &= CR_PER_Reset;
+ }
+ }
+#else
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(EraseTimeout);
+
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* if the previous operation is completed, proceed to erase the page */
+ FLASH->CR|= CR_PER_Set;
+ FLASH->AR = Page_Address;
+ FLASH->CR|= CR_STRT_Set;
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(EraseTimeout);
+
+ /* Disable the PER Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_PER_Reset;
+ }
+#endif /* STM32F10X_XL */
+
+ /* Return the Erase Status */
+ return status;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Erases all FLASH pages.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * @param None
+ * @retval FLASH Status: The returned value can be: FLASH_ERROR_PG,
+ * FLASH_ERROR_WRP, FLASH_COMPLETE or FLASH_TIMEOUT.
+ */
+FLASH_Status FLASH_EraseAllPages(void)
+{
+ FLASH_Status status = FLASH_COMPLETE;
+
+#ifdef STM32F10X_XL
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastBank1Operation(EraseTimeout);
+
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* if the previous operation is completed, proceed to erase all pages */
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_MER_Set;
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_STRT_Set;
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastBank1Operation(EraseTimeout);
+
+ /* Disable the MER Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_MER_Reset;
+ }
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* if the previous operation is completed, proceed to erase all pages */
+ FLASH->CR2 |= CR_MER_Set;
+ FLASH->CR2 |= CR_STRT_Set;
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastBank2Operation(EraseTimeout);
+
+ /* Disable the MER Bit */
+ FLASH->CR2 &= CR_MER_Reset;
+ }
+#else
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(EraseTimeout);
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* if the previous operation is completed, proceed to erase all pages */
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_MER_Set;
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_STRT_Set;
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(EraseTimeout);
+
+ /* Disable the MER Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_MER_Reset;
+ }
+#endif /* STM32F10X_XL */
+
+ /* Return the Erase Status */
+ return status;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Erases all Bank1 FLASH pages.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * - For STM32F10X_XL devices this function erases all Bank1 pages.
+ * - For all other devices it erases all Bank1 pages and it is equivalent
+ * to FLASH_EraseAllPages function.
+ * @param None
+ * @retval FLASH Status: The returned value can be: FLASH_ERROR_PG,
+ * FLASH_ERROR_WRP, FLASH_COMPLETE or FLASH_TIMEOUT.
+ */
+FLASH_Status FLASH_EraseAllBank1Pages(void)
+{
+ FLASH_Status status = FLASH_COMPLETE;
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastBank1Operation(EraseTimeout);
+
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* if the previous operation is completed, proceed to erase all pages */
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_MER_Set;
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_STRT_Set;
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastBank1Operation(EraseTimeout);
+
+ /* Disable the MER Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_MER_Reset;
+ }
+ /* Return the Erase Status */
+ return status;
+}
+
+#ifdef STM32F10X_XL
+/**
+ * @brief Erases all Bank2 FLASH pages.
+ * @note This function can be used only for STM32F10x_XL density devices.
+ * @param None
+ * @retval FLASH Status: The returned value can be: FLASH_ERROR_PG,
+ * FLASH_ERROR_WRP, FLASH_COMPLETE or FLASH_TIMEOUT.
+ */
+FLASH_Status FLASH_EraseAllBank2Pages(void)
+{
+ FLASH_Status status = FLASH_COMPLETE;
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastBank2Operation(EraseTimeout);
+
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* if the previous operation is completed, proceed to erase all pages */
+ FLASH->CR2 |= CR_MER_Set;
+ FLASH->CR2 |= CR_STRT_Set;
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastBank2Operation(EraseTimeout);
+
+ /* Disable the MER Bit */
+ FLASH->CR2 &= CR_MER_Reset;
+ }
+ /* Return the Erase Status */
+ return status;
+}
+#endif /* STM32F10X_XL */
+
+/**
+ * @brief Erases the FLASH option bytes.
+ * @note This functions erases all option bytes except the Read protection (RDP).
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * @param None
+ * @retval FLASH Status: The returned value can be: FLASH_ERROR_PG,
+ * FLASH_ERROR_WRP, FLASH_COMPLETE or FLASH_TIMEOUT.
+ */
+FLASH_Status FLASH_EraseOptionBytes(void)
+{
+ uint16_t rdptmp = RDP_Key;
+
+ FLASH_Status status = FLASH_COMPLETE;
+
+ /* Get the actual read protection Option Byte value */
+ if(FLASH_GetReadOutProtectionStatus() != RESET)
+ {
+ rdptmp = 0x00;
+ }
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(EraseTimeout);
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* Authorize the small information block programming */
+ FLASH->OPTKEYR = FLASH_KEY1;
+ FLASH->OPTKEYR = FLASH_KEY2;
+
+ /* if the previous operation is completed, proceed to erase the option bytes */
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_OPTER_Set;
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_STRT_Set;
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(EraseTimeout);
+
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* if the erase operation is completed, disable the OPTER Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_OPTER_Reset;
+
+ /* Enable the Option Bytes Programming operation */
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_OPTPG_Set;
+ /* Restore the last read protection Option Byte value */
+ OB->RDP = (uint16_t)rdptmp;
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ if(status != FLASH_TIMEOUT)
+ {
+ /* if the program operation is completed, disable the OPTPG Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_OPTPG_Reset;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if (status != FLASH_TIMEOUT)
+ {
+ /* Disable the OPTPG Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_OPTPG_Reset;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ /* Return the erase status */
+ return status;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Programs a word at a specified address.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * @param Address: specifies the address to be programmed.
+ * @param Data: specifies the data to be programmed.
+ * @retval FLASH Status: The returned value can be: FLASH_ERROR_PG,
+ * FLASH_ERROR_WRP, FLASH_COMPLETE or FLASH_TIMEOUT.
+ */
+FLASH_Status FLASH_ProgramWord(uint32_t Address, uint32_t Data)
+{
+ FLASH_Status status = FLASH_COMPLETE;
+ __IO uint32_t tmp = 0;
+
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_FLASH_ADDRESS(Address));
+
+#ifdef STM32F10X_XL
+ if(Address < FLASH_BANK1_END_ADDRESS - 2)
+ {
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastBank1Operation(ProgramTimeout);
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* if the previous operation is completed, proceed to program the new first
+ half word */
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_PG_Set;
+
+ *(__IO uint16_t*)Address = (uint16_t)Data;
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* if the previous operation is completed, proceed to program the new second
+ half word */
+ tmp = Address + 2;
+
+ *(__IO uint16_t*) tmp = Data >> 16;
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ /* Disable the PG Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_PG_Reset;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the PG Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_PG_Reset;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ else if(Address == (FLASH_BANK1_END_ADDRESS - 1))
+ {
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastBank1Operation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* if the previous operation is completed, proceed to program the new first
+ half word */
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_PG_Set;
+
+ *(__IO uint16_t*)Address = (uint16_t)Data;
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastBank1Operation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ /* Disable the PG Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_PG_Reset;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the PG Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_PG_Reset;
+ }
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastBank2Operation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* if the previous operation is completed, proceed to program the new second
+ half word */
+ FLASH->CR2 |= CR_PG_Set;
+ tmp = Address + 2;
+
+ *(__IO uint16_t*) tmp = Data >> 16;
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastBank2Operation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ /* Disable the PG Bit */
+ FLASH->CR2 &= CR_PG_Reset;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the PG Bit */
+ FLASH->CR2 &= CR_PG_Reset;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastBank2Operation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* if the previous operation is completed, proceed to program the new first
+ half word */
+ FLASH->CR2 |= CR_PG_Set;
+
+ *(__IO uint16_t*)Address = (uint16_t)Data;
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastBank2Operation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* if the previous operation is completed, proceed to program the new second
+ half word */
+ tmp = Address + 2;
+
+ *(__IO uint16_t*) tmp = Data >> 16;
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastBank2Operation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ /* Disable the PG Bit */
+ FLASH->CR2 &= CR_PG_Reset;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the PG Bit */
+ FLASH->CR2 &= CR_PG_Reset;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+#else
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* if the previous operation is completed, proceed to program the new first
+ half word */
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_PG_Set;
+
+ *(__IO uint16_t*)Address = (uint16_t)Data;
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* if the previous operation is completed, proceed to program the new second
+ half word */
+ tmp = Address + 2;
+
+ *(__IO uint16_t*) tmp = Data >> 16;
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ /* Disable the PG Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_PG_Reset;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the PG Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_PG_Reset;
+ }
+ }
+#endif /* STM32F10X_XL */
+
+ /* Return the Program Status */
+ return status;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Programs a half word at a specified address.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * @param Address: specifies the address to be programmed.
+ * @param Data: specifies the data to be programmed.
+ * @retval FLASH Status: The returned value can be: FLASH_ERROR_PG,
+ * FLASH_ERROR_WRP, FLASH_COMPLETE or FLASH_TIMEOUT.
+ */
+FLASH_Status FLASH_ProgramHalfWord(uint32_t Address, uint16_t Data)
+{
+ FLASH_Status status = FLASH_COMPLETE;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_FLASH_ADDRESS(Address));
+
+#ifdef STM32F10X_XL
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ if(Address < FLASH_BANK1_END_ADDRESS)
+ {
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* if the previous operation is completed, proceed to program the new data */
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_PG_Set;
+
+ *(__IO uint16_t*)Address = Data;
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastBank1Operation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ /* Disable the PG Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_PG_Reset;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* if the previous operation is completed, proceed to program the new data */
+ FLASH->CR2 |= CR_PG_Set;
+
+ *(__IO uint16_t*)Address = Data;
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastBank2Operation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ /* Disable the PG Bit */
+ FLASH->CR2 &= CR_PG_Reset;
+ }
+ }
+#else
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* if the previous operation is completed, proceed to program the new data */
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_PG_Set;
+
+ *(__IO uint16_t*)Address = Data;
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ /* Disable the PG Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_PG_Reset;
+ }
+#endif /* STM32F10X_XL */
+
+ /* Return the Program Status */
+ return status;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Programs a half word at a specified Option Byte Data address.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * @param Address: specifies the address to be programmed.
+ * This parameter can be 0x1FFFF804 or 0x1FFFF806.
+ * @param Data: specifies the data to be programmed.
+ * @retval FLASH Status: The returned value can be: FLASH_ERROR_PG,
+ * FLASH_ERROR_WRP, FLASH_COMPLETE or FLASH_TIMEOUT.
+ */
+FLASH_Status FLASH_ProgramOptionByteData(uint32_t Address, uint8_t Data)
+{
+ FLASH_Status status = FLASH_COMPLETE;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_OB_DATA_ADDRESS(Address));
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* Authorize the small information block programming */
+ FLASH->OPTKEYR = FLASH_KEY1;
+ FLASH->OPTKEYR = FLASH_KEY2;
+ /* Enables the Option Bytes Programming operation */
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_OPTPG_Set;
+ *(__IO uint16_t*)Address = Data;
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(ProgramTimeout);
+ if(status != FLASH_TIMEOUT)
+ {
+ /* if the program operation is completed, disable the OPTPG Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_OPTPG_Reset;
+ }
+ }
+ /* Return the Option Byte Data Program Status */
+ return status;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Write protects the desired pages
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * @param FLASH_Pages: specifies the address of the pages to be write protected.
+ * This parameter can be:
+ * @arg For @b STM32_Low-density_devices: value between FLASH_WRProt_Pages0to3 and FLASH_WRProt_Pages28to31
+ * @arg For @b STM32_Medium-density_devices: value between FLASH_WRProt_Pages0to3
+ * and FLASH_WRProt_Pages124to127
+ * @arg For @b STM32_High-density_devices: value between FLASH_WRProt_Pages0to1 and
+ * FLASH_WRProt_Pages60to61 or FLASH_WRProt_Pages62to255
+ * @arg For @b STM32_Connectivity_line_devices: value between FLASH_WRProt_Pages0to1 and
+ * FLASH_WRProt_Pages60to61 or FLASH_WRProt_Pages62to127
+ * @arg For @b STM32_XL-density_devices: value between FLASH_WRProt_Pages0to1 and
+ * FLASH_WRProt_Pages60to61 or FLASH_WRProt_Pages62to511
+ * @arg FLASH_WRProt_AllPages
+ * @retval FLASH Status: The returned value can be: FLASH_ERROR_PG,
+ * FLASH_ERROR_WRP, FLASH_COMPLETE or FLASH_TIMEOUT.
+ */
+FLASH_Status FLASH_EnableWriteProtection(uint32_t FLASH_Pages)
+{
+ uint16_t WRP0_Data = 0xFFFF, WRP1_Data = 0xFFFF, WRP2_Data = 0xFFFF, WRP3_Data = 0xFFFF;
+
+ FLASH_Status status = FLASH_COMPLETE;
+
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_FLASH_WRPROT_PAGE(FLASH_Pages));
+
+ FLASH_Pages = (uint32_t)(~FLASH_Pages);
+ WRP0_Data = (uint16_t)(FLASH_Pages & WRP0_Mask);
+ WRP1_Data = (uint16_t)((FLASH_Pages & WRP1_Mask) >> 8);
+ WRP2_Data = (uint16_t)((FLASH_Pages & WRP2_Mask) >> 16);
+ WRP3_Data = (uint16_t)((FLASH_Pages & WRP3_Mask) >> 24);
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* Authorizes the small information block programming */
+ FLASH->OPTKEYR = FLASH_KEY1;
+ FLASH->OPTKEYR = FLASH_KEY2;
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_OPTPG_Set;
+ if(WRP0_Data != 0xFF)
+ {
+ OB->WRP0 = WRP0_Data;
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(ProgramTimeout);
+ }
+ if((status == FLASH_COMPLETE) && (WRP1_Data != 0xFF))
+ {
+ OB->WRP1 = WRP1_Data;
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(ProgramTimeout);
+ }
+ if((status == FLASH_COMPLETE) && (WRP2_Data != 0xFF))
+ {
+ OB->WRP2 = WRP2_Data;
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(ProgramTimeout);
+ }
+
+ if((status == FLASH_COMPLETE)&& (WRP3_Data != 0xFF))
+ {
+ OB->WRP3 = WRP3_Data;
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(ProgramTimeout);
+ }
+
+ if(status != FLASH_TIMEOUT)
+ {
+ /* if the program operation is completed, disable the OPTPG Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_OPTPG_Reset;
+ }
+ }
+ /* Return the write protection operation Status */
+ return status;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the read out protection.
+ * @note If the user has already programmed the other option bytes before calling
+ * this function, he must re-program them since this function erases all option bytes.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * @param Newstate: new state of the ReadOut Protection.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval FLASH Status: The returned value can be: FLASH_ERROR_PG,
+ * FLASH_ERROR_WRP, FLASH_COMPLETE or FLASH_TIMEOUT.
+ */
+FLASH_Status FLASH_ReadOutProtection(FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ FLASH_Status status = FLASH_COMPLETE;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(EraseTimeout);
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* Authorizes the small information block programming */
+ FLASH->OPTKEYR = FLASH_KEY1;
+ FLASH->OPTKEYR = FLASH_KEY2;
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_OPTER_Set;
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_STRT_Set;
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(EraseTimeout);
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* if the erase operation is completed, disable the OPTER Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_OPTER_Reset;
+ /* Enable the Option Bytes Programming operation */
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_OPTPG_Set;
+ if(NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ OB->RDP = 0x00;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ OB->RDP = RDP_Key;
+ }
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(EraseTimeout);
+
+ if(status != FLASH_TIMEOUT)
+ {
+ /* if the program operation is completed, disable the OPTPG Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_OPTPG_Reset;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if(status != FLASH_TIMEOUT)
+ {
+ /* Disable the OPTER Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_OPTER_Reset;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ /* Return the protection operation Status */
+ return status;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Programs the FLASH User Option Byte: IWDG_SW / RST_STOP / RST_STDBY.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * @param OB_IWDG: Selects the IWDG mode
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg OB_IWDG_SW: Software IWDG selected
+ * @arg OB_IWDG_HW: Hardware IWDG selected
+ * @param OB_STOP: Reset event when entering STOP mode.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg OB_STOP_NoRST: No reset generated when entering in STOP
+ * @arg OB_STOP_RST: Reset generated when entering in STOP
+ * @param OB_STDBY: Reset event when entering Standby mode.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg OB_STDBY_NoRST: No reset generated when entering in STANDBY
+ * @arg OB_STDBY_RST: Reset generated when entering in STANDBY
+ * @retval FLASH Status: The returned value can be: FLASH_ERROR_PG,
+ * FLASH_ERROR_WRP, FLASH_COMPLETE or FLASH_TIMEOUT.
+ */
+FLASH_Status FLASH_UserOptionByteConfig(uint16_t OB_IWDG, uint16_t OB_STOP, uint16_t OB_STDBY)
+{
+ FLASH_Status status = FLASH_COMPLETE;
+
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_OB_IWDG_SOURCE(OB_IWDG));
+ assert_param(IS_OB_STOP_SOURCE(OB_STOP));
+ assert_param(IS_OB_STDBY_SOURCE(OB_STDBY));
+
+ /* Authorize the small information block programming */
+ FLASH->OPTKEYR = FLASH_KEY1;
+ FLASH->OPTKEYR = FLASH_KEY2;
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the Option Bytes Programming operation */
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_OPTPG_Set;
+
+ OB->USER = OB_IWDG | (uint16_t)(OB_STOP | (uint16_t)(OB_STDBY | ((uint16_t)0xF8)));
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(ProgramTimeout);
+ if(status != FLASH_TIMEOUT)
+ {
+ /* if the program operation is completed, disable the OPTPG Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_OPTPG_Reset;
+ }
+ }
+ /* Return the Option Byte program Status */
+ return status;
+}
+
+#ifdef STM32F10X_XL
+/**
+ * @brief Configures to boot from Bank1 or Bank2.
+ * @note This function can be used only for STM32F10x_XL density devices.
+ * @param FLASH_BOOT: select the FLASH Bank to boot from.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg FLASH_BOOT_Bank1: At startup, if boot pins are set in boot from user Flash
+ * position and this parameter is selected the device will boot from Bank1(Default).
+ * @arg FLASH_BOOT_Bank2: At startup, if boot pins are set in boot from user Flash
+ * position and this parameter is selected the device will boot from Bank2 or Bank1,
+ * depending on the activation of the bank. The active banks are checked in
+ * the following order: Bank2, followed by Bank1.
+ * The active bank is recognized by the value programmed at the base address
+ * of the respective bank (corresponding to the initial stack pointer value
+ * in the interrupt vector table).
+ * For more information, please refer to AN2606 from www.st.com.
+ * @retval FLASH Status: The returned value can be: FLASH_ERROR_PG,
+ * FLASH_ERROR_WRP, FLASH_COMPLETE or FLASH_TIMEOUT.
+ */
+FLASH_Status FLASH_BootConfig(uint16_t FLASH_BOOT)
+{
+ FLASH_Status status = FLASH_COMPLETE;
+ assert_param(IS_FLASH_BOOT(FLASH_BOOT));
+ /* Authorize the small information block programming */
+ FLASH->OPTKEYR = FLASH_KEY1;
+ FLASH->OPTKEYR = FLASH_KEY2;
+
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(ProgramTimeout);
+
+ if(status == FLASH_COMPLETE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the Option Bytes Programming operation */
+ FLASH->CR |= CR_OPTPG_Set;
+
+ if(FLASH_BOOT == FLASH_BOOT_Bank1)
+ {
+ OB->USER |= OB_USER_BFB2;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ OB->USER &= (uint16_t)(~(uint16_t)(OB_USER_BFB2));
+ }
+ /* Wait for last operation to be completed */
+ status = FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(ProgramTimeout);
+ if(status != FLASH_TIMEOUT)
+ {
+ /* if the program operation is completed, disable the OPTPG Bit */
+ FLASH->CR &= CR_OPTPG_Reset;
+ }
+ }
+ /* Return the Option Byte program Status */
+ return status;
+}
+#endif /* STM32F10X_XL */
+
+/**
+ * @brief Returns the FLASH User Option Bytes values.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * @param None
+ * @retval The FLASH User Option Bytes values:IWDG_SW(Bit0), RST_STOP(Bit1)
+ * and RST_STDBY(Bit2).
+ */
+uint32_t FLASH_GetUserOptionByte(void)
+{
+ /* Return the User Option Byte */
+ return (uint32_t)(FLASH->OBR >> 2);
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Returns the FLASH Write Protection Option Bytes Register value.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * @param None
+ * @retval The FLASH Write Protection Option Bytes Register value
+ */
+uint32_t FLASH_GetWriteProtectionOptionByte(void)
+{
+ /* Return the Falsh write protection Register value */
+ return (uint32_t)(FLASH->WRPR);
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Checks whether the FLASH Read Out Protection Status is set or not.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * @param None
+ * @retval FLASH ReadOut Protection Status(SET or RESET)
+ */
+FlagStatus FLASH_GetReadOutProtectionStatus(void)
+{
+ FlagStatus readoutstatus = RESET;
+ if ((FLASH->OBR & RDPRT_Mask) != (uint32_t)RESET)
+ {
+ readoutstatus = SET;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ readoutstatus = RESET;
+ }
+ return readoutstatus;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Checks whether the FLASH Prefetch Buffer status is set or not.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * @param None
+ * @retval FLASH Prefetch Buffer Status (SET or RESET).
+ */
+FlagStatus FLASH_GetPrefetchBufferStatus(void)
+{
+ FlagStatus bitstatus = RESET;
+
+ if ((FLASH->ACR & ACR_PRFTBS_Mask) != (uint32_t)RESET)
+ {
+ bitstatus = SET;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ bitstatus = RESET;
+ }
+ /* Return the new state of FLASH Prefetch Buffer Status (SET or RESET) */
+ return bitstatus;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the specified FLASH interrupts.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * - For STM32F10X_XL devices, enables or disables the specified FLASH interrupts
+ for Bank1 and Bank2.
+ * - For other devices it enables or disables the specified FLASH interrupts for Bank1.
+ * @param FLASH_IT: specifies the FLASH interrupt sources to be enabled or disabled.
+ * This parameter can be any combination of the following values:
+ * @arg FLASH_IT_ERROR: FLASH Error Interrupt
+ * @arg FLASH_IT_EOP: FLASH end of operation Interrupt
+ * @param NewState: new state of the specified Flash interrupts.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void FLASH_ITConfig(uint32_t FLASH_IT, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+#ifdef STM32F10X_XL
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_FLASH_IT(FLASH_IT));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+
+ if((FLASH_IT & 0x80000000) != 0x0)
+ {
+ if(NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the interrupt sources */
+ FLASH->CR2 |= (FLASH_IT & 0x7FFFFFFF);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the interrupt sources */
+ FLASH->CR2 &= ~(uint32_t)(FLASH_IT & 0x7FFFFFFF);
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if(NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the interrupt sources */
+ FLASH->CR |= FLASH_IT;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the interrupt sources */
+ FLASH->CR &= ~(uint32_t)FLASH_IT;
+ }
+ }
+#else
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_FLASH_IT(FLASH_IT));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+
+ if(NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the interrupt sources */
+ FLASH->CR |= FLASH_IT;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the interrupt sources */
+ FLASH->CR &= ~(uint32_t)FLASH_IT;
+ }
+#endif /* STM32F10X_XL */
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Checks whether the specified FLASH flag is set or not.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * - For STM32F10X_XL devices, this function checks whether the specified
+ * Bank1 or Bank2 flag is set or not.
+ * - For other devices, it checks whether the specified Bank1 flag is
+ * set or not.
+ * @param FLASH_FLAG: specifies the FLASH flag to check.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg FLASH_FLAG_BSY: FLASH Busy flag
+ * @arg FLASH_FLAG_PGERR: FLASH Program error flag
+ * @arg FLASH_FLAG_WRPRTERR: FLASH Write protected error flag
+ * @arg FLASH_FLAG_EOP: FLASH End of Operation flag
+ * @arg FLASH_FLAG_OPTERR: FLASH Option Byte error flag
+ * @retval The new state of FLASH_FLAG (SET or RESET).
+ */
+FlagStatus FLASH_GetFlagStatus(uint32_t FLASH_FLAG)
+{
+ FlagStatus bitstatus = RESET;
+
+#ifdef STM32F10X_XL
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_FLASH_GET_FLAG(FLASH_FLAG)) ;
+ if(FLASH_FLAG == FLASH_FLAG_OPTERR)
+ {
+ if((FLASH->OBR & FLASH_FLAG_OPTERR) != (uint32_t)RESET)
+ {
+ bitstatus = SET;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ bitstatus = RESET;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if((FLASH_FLAG & 0x80000000) != 0x0)
+ {
+ if((FLASH->SR2 & FLASH_FLAG) != (uint32_t)RESET)
+ {
+ bitstatus = SET;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ bitstatus = RESET;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if((FLASH->SR & FLASH_FLAG) != (uint32_t)RESET)
+ {
+ bitstatus = SET;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ bitstatus = RESET;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+#else
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_FLASH_GET_FLAG(FLASH_FLAG)) ;
+ if(FLASH_FLAG == FLASH_FLAG_OPTERR)
+ {
+ if((FLASH->OBR & FLASH_FLAG_OPTERR) != (uint32_t)RESET)
+ {
+ bitstatus = SET;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ bitstatus = RESET;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if((FLASH->SR & FLASH_FLAG) != (uint32_t)RESET)
+ {
+ bitstatus = SET;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ bitstatus = RESET;
+ }
+ }
+#endif /* STM32F10X_XL */
+
+ /* Return the new state of FLASH_FLAG (SET or RESET) */
+ return bitstatus;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Clears the FLASH’s pending flags.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices.
+ * - For STM32F10X_XL devices, this function clears Bank1 or Bank2’s pending flags
+ * - For other devices, it clears Bank1’s pending flags.
+ * @param FLASH_FLAG: specifies the FLASH flags to clear.
+ * This parameter can be any combination of the following values:
+ * @arg FLASH_FLAG_PGERR: FLASH Program error flag
+ * @arg FLASH_FLAG_WRPRTERR: FLASH Write protected error flag
+ * @arg FLASH_FLAG_EOP: FLASH End of Operation flag
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void FLASH_ClearFlag(uint32_t FLASH_FLAG)
+{
+#ifdef STM32F10X_XL
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_FLASH_CLEAR_FLAG(FLASH_FLAG)) ;
+
+ if((FLASH_FLAG & 0x80000000) != 0x0)
+ {
+ /* Clear the flags */
+ FLASH->SR2 = FLASH_FLAG;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Clear the flags */
+ FLASH->SR = FLASH_FLAG;
+ }
+
+#else
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_FLASH_CLEAR_FLAG(FLASH_FLAG)) ;
+
+ /* Clear the flags */
+ FLASH->SR = FLASH_FLAG;
+#endif /* STM32F10X_XL */
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Returns the FLASH Status.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices, it is equivalent
+ * to FLASH_GetBank1Status function.
+ * @param None
+ * @retval FLASH Status: The returned value can be: FLASH_BUSY, FLASH_ERROR_PG,
+ * FLASH_ERROR_WRP or FLASH_COMPLETE
+ */
+FLASH_Status FLASH_GetStatus(void)
+{
+ FLASH_Status flashstatus = FLASH_COMPLETE;
+
+ if((FLASH->SR & FLASH_FLAG_BSY) == FLASH_FLAG_BSY)
+ {
+ flashstatus = FLASH_BUSY;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if((FLASH->SR & FLASH_FLAG_PGERR) != 0)
+ {
+ flashstatus = FLASH_ERROR_PG;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if((FLASH->SR & FLASH_FLAG_WRPRTERR) != 0 )
+ {
+ flashstatus = FLASH_ERROR_WRP;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ flashstatus = FLASH_COMPLETE;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ /* Return the Flash Status */
+ return flashstatus;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Returns the FLASH Bank1 Status.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices, it is equivalent
+ * to FLASH_GetStatus function.
+ * @param None
+ * @retval FLASH Status: The returned value can be: FLASH_BUSY, FLASH_ERROR_PG,
+ * FLASH_ERROR_WRP or FLASH_COMPLETE
+ */
+FLASH_Status FLASH_GetBank1Status(void)
+{
+ FLASH_Status flashstatus = FLASH_COMPLETE;
+
+ if((FLASH->SR & FLASH_FLAG_BANK1_BSY) == FLASH_FLAG_BSY)
+ {
+ flashstatus = FLASH_BUSY;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if((FLASH->SR & FLASH_FLAG_BANK1_PGERR) != 0)
+ {
+ flashstatus = FLASH_ERROR_PG;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if((FLASH->SR & FLASH_FLAG_BANK1_WRPRTERR) != 0 )
+ {
+ flashstatus = FLASH_ERROR_WRP;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ flashstatus = FLASH_COMPLETE;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ /* Return the Flash Status */
+ return flashstatus;
+}
+
+#ifdef STM32F10X_XL
+/**
+ * @brief Returns the FLASH Bank2 Status.
+ * @note This function can be used for STM32F10x_XL density devices.
+ * @param None
+ * @retval FLASH Status: The returned value can be: FLASH_BUSY, FLASH_ERROR_PG,
+ * FLASH_ERROR_WRP or FLASH_COMPLETE
+ */
+FLASH_Status FLASH_GetBank2Status(void)
+{
+ FLASH_Status flashstatus = FLASH_COMPLETE;
+
+ if((FLASH->SR2 & (FLASH_FLAG_BANK2_BSY & 0x7FFFFFFF)) == (FLASH_FLAG_BANK2_BSY & 0x7FFFFFFF))
+ {
+ flashstatus = FLASH_BUSY;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if((FLASH->SR2 & (FLASH_FLAG_BANK2_PGERR & 0x7FFFFFFF)) != 0)
+ {
+ flashstatus = FLASH_ERROR_PG;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if((FLASH->SR2 & (FLASH_FLAG_BANK2_WRPRTERR & 0x7FFFFFFF)) != 0 )
+ {
+ flashstatus = FLASH_ERROR_WRP;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ flashstatus = FLASH_COMPLETE;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ /* Return the Flash Status */
+ return flashstatus;
+}
+#endif /* STM32F10X_XL */
+/**
+ * @brief Waits for a Flash operation to complete or a TIMEOUT to occur.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices,
+ * it is equivalent to FLASH_WaitForLastBank1Operation.
+ * - For STM32F10X_XL devices this function waits for a Bank1 Flash operation
+ * to complete or a TIMEOUT to occur.
+ * - For all other devices it waits for a Flash operation to complete
+ * or a TIMEOUT to occur.
+ * @param Timeout: FLASH progamming Timeout
+ * @retval FLASH Status: The returned value can be: FLASH_ERROR_PG,
+ * FLASH_ERROR_WRP, FLASH_COMPLETE or FLASH_TIMEOUT.
+ */
+FLASH_Status FLASH_WaitForLastOperation(uint32_t Timeout)
+{
+ FLASH_Status status = FLASH_COMPLETE;
+
+ /* Check for the Flash Status */
+ status = FLASH_GetBank1Status();
+ /* Wait for a Flash operation to complete or a TIMEOUT to occur */
+ while((status == FLASH_BUSY) && (Timeout != 0x00))
+ {
+ status = FLASH_GetBank1Status();
+ Timeout--;
+ }
+ if(Timeout == 0x00 )
+ {
+ status = FLASH_TIMEOUT;
+ }
+ /* Return the operation status */
+ return status;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Waits for a Flash operation on Bank1 to complete or a TIMEOUT to occur.
+ * @note This function can be used for all STM32F10x devices,
+ * it is equivalent to FLASH_WaitForLastOperation.
+ * @param Timeout: FLASH progamming Timeout
+ * @retval FLASH Status: The returned value can be: FLASH_ERROR_PG,
+ * FLASH_ERROR_WRP, FLASH_COMPLETE or FLASH_TIMEOUT.
+ */
+FLASH_Status FLASH_WaitForLastBank1Operation(uint32_t Timeout)
+{
+ FLASH_Status status = FLASH_COMPLETE;
+
+ /* Check for the Flash Status */
+ status = FLASH_GetBank1Status();
+ /* Wait for a Flash operation to complete or a TIMEOUT to occur */
+ while((status == FLASH_FLAG_BANK1_BSY) && (Timeout != 0x00))
+ {
+ status = FLASH_GetBank1Status();
+ Timeout--;
+ }
+ if(Timeout == 0x00 )
+ {
+ status = FLASH_TIMEOUT;
+ }
+ /* Return the operation status */
+ return status;
+}
+
+#ifdef STM32F10X_XL
+/**
+ * @brief Waits for a Flash operation on Bank2 to complete or a TIMEOUT to occur.
+ * @note This function can be used only for STM32F10x_XL density devices.
+ * @param Timeout: FLASH progamming Timeout
+ * @retval FLASH Status: The returned value can be: FLASH_ERROR_PG,
+ * FLASH_ERROR_WRP, FLASH_COMPLETE or FLASH_TIMEOUT.
+ */
+FLASH_Status FLASH_WaitForLastBank2Operation(uint32_t Timeout)
+{
+ FLASH_Status status = FLASH_COMPLETE;
+
+ /* Check for the Flash Status */
+ status = FLASH_GetBank2Status();
+ /* Wait for a Flash operation to complete or a TIMEOUT to occur */
+ while((status == (FLASH_FLAG_BANK2_BSY & 0x7FFFFFFF)) && (Timeout != 0x00))
+ {
+ status = FLASH_GetBank2Status();
+ Timeout--;
+ }
+ if(Timeout == 0x00 )
+ {
+ status = FLASH_TIMEOUT;
+ }
+ /* Return the operation status */
+ return status;
+}
+#endif /* STM32F10X_XL */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/******************* (C) COPYRIGHT 2010 STMicroelectronics *****END OF FILE****/
diff --git a/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Libraries/STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver/src/stm32f10x_fsmc.c b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Libraries/STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver/src/stm32f10x_fsmc.c
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..db9a5aad1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Libraries/STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver/src/stm32f10x_fsmc.c
@@ -0,0 +1,863 @@
+/**
+ ******************************************************************************
+ * @file stm32f10x_fsmc.c
+ * @author MCD Application Team
+ * @version V3.4.0
+ * @date 10/15/2010
+ * @brief This file provides all the FSMC firmware functions.
+ ******************************************************************************
+ * @copy
+ *
+ * THE PRESENT FIRMWARE WHICH IS FOR GUIDANCE ONLY AIMS AT PROVIDING CUSTOMERS
+ * WITH CODING INFORMATION REGARDING THEIR PRODUCTS IN ORDER FOR THEM TO SAVE
+ * TIME. AS A RESULT, STMICROELECTRONICS SHALL NOT BE HELD LIABLE FOR ANY
+ * DIRECT, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES WITH RESPECT TO ANY CLAIMS ARISING
+ * FROM THE CONTENT OF SUCH FIRMWARE AND/OR THE USE MADE BY CUSTOMERS OF THE
+ * CODING INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN IN CONNECTION WITH THEIR PRODUCTS.
+ *
+ *
+ */
+
+/* Includes ------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+#include "stm32f10x_i2c.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_rcc.h"
+
+
+/** @addtogroup STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C
+ * @brief I2C driver modules
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_Private_TypesDefinitions
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_Private_Defines
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/* I2C SPE mask */
+#define CR1_PE_Set ((uint16_t)0x0001)
+#define CR1_PE_Reset ((uint16_t)0xFFFE)
+
+/* I2C START mask */
+#define CR1_START_Set ((uint16_t)0x0100)
+#define CR1_START_Reset ((uint16_t)0xFEFF)
+
+/* I2C STOP mask */
+#define CR1_STOP_Set ((uint16_t)0x0200)
+#define CR1_STOP_Reset ((uint16_t)0xFDFF)
+
+/* I2C ACK mask */
+#define CR1_ACK_Set ((uint16_t)0x0400)
+#define CR1_ACK_Reset ((uint16_t)0xFBFF)
+
+/* I2C ENGC mask */
+#define CR1_ENGC_Set ((uint16_t)0x0040)
+#define CR1_ENGC_Reset ((uint16_t)0xFFBF)
+
+/* I2C SWRST mask */
+#define CR1_SWRST_Set ((uint16_t)0x8000)
+#define CR1_SWRST_Reset ((uint16_t)0x7FFF)
+
+/* I2C PEC mask */
+#define CR1_PEC_Set ((uint16_t)0x1000)
+#define CR1_PEC_Reset ((uint16_t)0xEFFF)
+
+/* I2C ENPEC mask */
+#define CR1_ENPEC_Set ((uint16_t)0x0020)
+#define CR1_ENPEC_Reset ((uint16_t)0xFFDF)
+
+/* I2C ENARP mask */
+#define CR1_ENARP_Set ((uint16_t)0x0010)
+#define CR1_ENARP_Reset ((uint16_t)0xFFEF)
+
+/* I2C NOSTRETCH mask */
+#define CR1_NOSTRETCH_Set ((uint16_t)0x0080)
+#define CR1_NOSTRETCH_Reset ((uint16_t)0xFF7F)
+
+/* I2C registers Masks */
+#define CR1_CLEAR_Mask ((uint16_t)0xFBF5)
+
+/* I2C DMAEN mask */
+#define CR2_DMAEN_Set ((uint16_t)0x0800)
+#define CR2_DMAEN_Reset ((uint16_t)0xF7FF)
+
+/* I2C LAST mask */
+#define CR2_LAST_Set ((uint16_t)0x1000)
+#define CR2_LAST_Reset ((uint16_t)0xEFFF)
+
+/* I2C FREQ mask */
+#define CR2_FREQ_Reset ((uint16_t)0xFFC0)
+
+/* I2C ADD0 mask */
+#define OAR1_ADD0_Set ((uint16_t)0x0001)
+#define OAR1_ADD0_Reset ((uint16_t)0xFFFE)
+
+/* I2C ENDUAL mask */
+#define OAR2_ENDUAL_Set ((uint16_t)0x0001)
+#define OAR2_ENDUAL_Reset ((uint16_t)0xFFFE)
+
+/* I2C ADD2 mask */
+#define OAR2_ADD2_Reset ((uint16_t)0xFF01)
+
+/* I2C F/S mask */
+#define CCR_FS_Set ((uint16_t)0x8000)
+
+/* I2C CCR mask */
+#define CCR_CCR_Set ((uint16_t)0x0FFF)
+
+/* I2C FLAG mask */
+#define FLAG_Mask ((uint32_t)0x00FFFFFF)
+
+/* I2C Interrupt Enable mask */
+#define ITEN_Mask ((uint32_t)0x07000000)
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_Private_Macros
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_Private_Variables
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_Private_FunctionPrototypes
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup I2C_Private_Functions
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @brief Deinitializes the I2Cx peripheral registers to their default reset values.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void I2C_DeInit(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+
+ if (I2Cx == I2C1)
+ {
+ /* Enable I2C1 reset state */
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_I2C1, ENABLE);
+ /* Release I2C1 from reset state */
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_I2C1, DISABLE);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Enable I2C2 reset state */
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_I2C2, ENABLE);
+ /* Release I2C2 from reset state */
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_I2C2, DISABLE);
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Initializes the I2Cx peripheral according to the specified
+ * parameters in the I2C_InitStruct.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param I2C_InitStruct: pointer to a I2C_InitTypeDef structure that
+ * contains the configuration information for the specified I2C peripheral.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void I2C_Init(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, I2C_InitTypeDef* I2C_InitStruct)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpreg = 0, freqrange = 0;
+ uint16_t result = 0x04;
+ uint32_t pclk1 = 8000000;
+ RCC_ClocksTypeDef rcc_clocks;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_CLOCK_SPEED(I2C_InitStruct->I2C_ClockSpeed));
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_MODE(I2C_InitStruct->I2C_Mode));
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_DUTY_CYCLE(I2C_InitStruct->I2C_DutyCycle));
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_OWN_ADDRESS1(I2C_InitStruct->I2C_OwnAddress1));
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ACK_STATE(I2C_InitStruct->I2C_Ack));
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ACKNOWLEDGE_ADDRESS(I2C_InitStruct->I2C_AcknowledgedAddress));
+
+/*---------------------------- I2Cx CR2 Configuration ------------------------*/
+ /* Get the I2Cx CR2 value */
+ tmpreg = I2Cx->CR2;
+ /* Clear frequency FREQ[5:0] bits */
+ tmpreg &= CR2_FREQ_Reset;
+ /* Get pclk1 frequency value */
+ RCC_GetClocksFreq(&rcc_clocks);
+ pclk1 = rcc_clocks.PCLK1_Frequency;
+ /* Set frequency bits depending on pclk1 value */
+ freqrange = (uint16_t)(pclk1 / 1000000);
+ tmpreg |= freqrange;
+ /* Write to I2Cx CR2 */
+ I2Cx->CR2 = tmpreg;
+
+/*---------------------------- I2Cx CCR Configuration ------------------------*/
+ /* Disable the selected I2C peripheral to configure TRISE */
+ I2Cx->CR1 &= CR1_PE_Reset;
+ /* Reset tmpreg value */
+ /* Clear F/S, DUTY and CCR[11:0] bits */
+ tmpreg = 0;
+
+ /* Configure speed in standard mode */
+ if (I2C_InitStruct->I2C_ClockSpeed <= 100000)
+ {
+ /* Standard mode speed calculate */
+ result = (uint16_t)(pclk1 / (I2C_InitStruct->I2C_ClockSpeed << 1));
+ /* Test if CCR value is under 0x4*/
+ if (result < 0x04)
+ {
+ /* Set minimum allowed value */
+ result = 0x04;
+ }
+ /* Set speed value for standard mode */
+ tmpreg |= result;
+ /* Set Maximum Rise Time for standard mode */
+ I2Cx->TRISE = freqrange + 1;
+ }
+ /* Configure speed in fast mode */
+ else /*(I2C_InitStruct->I2C_ClockSpeed <= 400000)*/
+ {
+ if (I2C_InitStruct->I2C_DutyCycle == I2C_DutyCycle_2)
+ {
+ /* Fast mode speed calculate: Tlow/Thigh = 2 */
+ result = (uint16_t)(pclk1 / (I2C_InitStruct->I2C_ClockSpeed * 3));
+ }
+ else /*I2C_InitStruct->I2C_DutyCycle == I2C_DutyCycle_16_9*/
+ {
+ /* Fast mode speed calculate: Tlow/Thigh = 16/9 */
+ result = (uint16_t)(pclk1 / (I2C_InitStruct->I2C_ClockSpeed * 25));
+ /* Set DUTY bit */
+ result |= I2C_DutyCycle_16_9;
+ }
+
+ /* Test if CCR value is under 0x1*/
+ if ((result & CCR_CCR_Set) == 0)
+ {
+ /* Set minimum allowed value */
+ result |= (uint16_t)0x0001;
+ }
+ /* Set speed value and set F/S bit for fast mode */
+ tmpreg |= (uint16_t)(result | CCR_FS_Set);
+ /* Set Maximum Rise Time for fast mode */
+ I2Cx->TRISE = (uint16_t)(((freqrange * (uint16_t)300) / (uint16_t)1000) + (uint16_t)1);
+ }
+
+ /* Write to I2Cx CCR */
+ I2Cx->CCR = tmpreg;
+ /* Enable the selected I2C peripheral */
+ I2Cx->CR1 |= CR1_PE_Set;
+
+/*---------------------------- I2Cx CR1 Configuration ------------------------*/
+ /* Get the I2Cx CR1 value */
+ tmpreg = I2Cx->CR1;
+ /* Clear ACK, SMBTYPE and SMBUS bits */
+ tmpreg &= CR1_CLEAR_Mask;
+ /* Configure I2Cx: mode and acknowledgement */
+ /* Set SMBTYPE and SMBUS bits according to I2C_Mode value */
+ /* Set ACK bit according to I2C_Ack value */
+ tmpreg |= (uint16_t)((uint32_t)I2C_InitStruct->I2C_Mode | I2C_InitStruct->I2C_Ack);
+ /* Write to I2Cx CR1 */
+ I2Cx->CR1 = tmpreg;
+
+/*---------------------------- I2Cx OAR1 Configuration -----------------------*/
+ /* Set I2Cx Own Address1 and acknowledged address */
+ I2Cx->OAR1 = (I2C_InitStruct->I2C_AcknowledgedAddress | I2C_InitStruct->I2C_OwnAddress1);
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Fills each I2C_InitStruct member with its default value.
+ * @param I2C_InitStruct: pointer to an I2C_InitTypeDef structure which will be initialized.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void I2C_StructInit(I2C_InitTypeDef* I2C_InitStruct)
+{
+/*---------------- Reset I2C init structure parameters values ----------------*/
+ /* initialize the I2C_ClockSpeed member */
+ I2C_InitStruct->I2C_ClockSpeed = 5000;
+ /* Initialize the I2C_Mode member */
+ I2C_InitStruct->I2C_Mode = I2C_Mode_I2C;
+ /* Initialize the I2C_DutyCycle member */
+ I2C_InitStruct->I2C_DutyCycle = I2C_DutyCycle_2;
+ /* Initialize the I2C_OwnAddress1 member */
+ I2C_InitStruct->I2C_OwnAddress1 = 0;
+ /* Initialize the I2C_Ack member */
+ I2C_InitStruct->I2C_Ack = I2C_Ack_Disable;
+ /* Initialize the I2C_AcknowledgedAddress member */
+ I2C_InitStruct->I2C_AcknowledgedAddress = I2C_AcknowledgedAddress_7bit;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the specified I2C peripheral.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the I2Cx peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void I2C_Cmd(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the selected I2C peripheral */
+ I2Cx->CR1 |= CR1_PE_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the selected I2C peripheral */
+ I2Cx->CR1 &= CR1_PE_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the specified I2C DMA requests.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the I2C DMA transfer.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void I2C_DMACmd(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the selected I2C DMA requests */
+ I2Cx->CR2 |= CR2_DMAEN_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the selected I2C DMA requests */
+ I2Cx->CR2 &= CR2_DMAEN_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Specifies if the next DMA transfer will be the last one.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the I2C DMA last transfer.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void I2C_DMALastTransferCmd(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Next DMA transfer is the last transfer */
+ I2Cx->CR2 |= CR2_LAST_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Next DMA transfer is not the last transfer */
+ I2Cx->CR2 &= CR2_LAST_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Generates I2Cx communication START condition.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the I2C START condition generation.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None.
+ */
+void I2C_GenerateSTART(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Generate a START condition */
+ I2Cx->CR1 |= CR1_START_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the START condition generation */
+ I2Cx->CR1 &= CR1_START_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Generates I2Cx communication STOP condition.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the I2C STOP condition generation.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None.
+ */
+void I2C_GenerateSTOP(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Generate a STOP condition */
+ I2Cx->CR1 |= CR1_STOP_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the STOP condition generation */
+ I2Cx->CR1 &= CR1_STOP_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the specified I2C acknowledge feature.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the I2C Acknowledgement.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None.
+ */
+void I2C_AcknowledgeConfig(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the acknowledgement */
+ I2Cx->CR1 |= CR1_ACK_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the acknowledgement */
+ I2Cx->CR1 &= CR1_ACK_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the specified I2C own address2.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param Address: specifies the 7bit I2C own address2.
+ * @retval None.
+ */
+void I2C_OwnAddress2Config(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint8_t Address)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpreg = 0;
+
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+
+ /* Get the old register value */
+ tmpreg = I2Cx->OAR2;
+
+ /* Reset I2Cx Own address2 bit [7:1] */
+ tmpreg &= OAR2_ADD2_Reset;
+
+ /* Set I2Cx Own address2 */
+ tmpreg |= (uint16_t)((uint16_t)Address & (uint16_t)0x00FE);
+
+ /* Store the new register value */
+ I2Cx->OAR2 = tmpreg;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the specified I2C dual addressing mode.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the I2C dual addressing mode.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void I2C_DualAddressCmd(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable dual addressing mode */
+ I2Cx->OAR2 |= OAR2_ENDUAL_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable dual addressing mode */
+ I2Cx->OAR2 &= OAR2_ENDUAL_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the specified I2C general call feature.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the I2C General call.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void I2C_GeneralCallCmd(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable generall call */
+ I2Cx->CR1 |= CR1_ENGC_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable generall call */
+ I2Cx->CR1 &= CR1_ENGC_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the specified I2C interrupts.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param I2C_IT: specifies the I2C interrupts sources to be enabled or disabled.
+ * This parameter can be any combination of the following values:
+ * @arg I2C_IT_BUF: Buffer interrupt mask
+ * @arg I2C_IT_EVT: Event interrupt mask
+ * @arg I2C_IT_ERR: Error interrupt mask
+ * @param NewState: new state of the specified I2C interrupts.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void I2C_ITConfig(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint16_t I2C_IT, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_CONFIG_IT(I2C_IT));
+
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the selected I2C interrupts */
+ I2Cx->CR2 |= I2C_IT;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the selected I2C interrupts */
+ I2Cx->CR2 &= (uint16_t)~I2C_IT;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sends a data byte through the I2Cx peripheral.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param Data: Byte to be transmitted..
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void I2C_SendData(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint8_t Data)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ /* Write in the DR register the data to be sent */
+ I2Cx->DR = Data;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Returns the most recent received data by the I2Cx peripheral.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @retval The value of the received data.
+ */
+uint8_t I2C_ReceiveData(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ /* Return the data in the DR register */
+ return (uint8_t)I2Cx->DR;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Transmits the address byte to select the slave device.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param Address: specifies the slave address which will be transmitted
+ * @param I2C_Direction: specifies whether the I2C device will be a
+ * Transmitter or a Receiver. This parameter can be one of the following values
+ * @arg I2C_Direction_Transmitter: Transmitter mode
+ * @arg I2C_Direction_Receiver: Receiver mode
+ * @retval None.
+ */
+void I2C_Send7bitAddress(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint8_t Address, uint8_t I2C_Direction)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_DIRECTION(I2C_Direction));
+ /* Test on the direction to set/reset the read/write bit */
+ if (I2C_Direction != I2C_Direction_Transmitter)
+ {
+ /* Set the address bit0 for read */
+ Address |= OAR1_ADD0_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Reset the address bit0 for write */
+ Address &= OAR1_ADD0_Reset;
+ }
+ /* Send the address */
+ I2Cx->DR = Address;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Reads the specified I2C register and returns its value.
+ * @param I2C_Register: specifies the register to read.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg I2C_Register_CR1: CR1 register.
+ * @arg I2C_Register_CR2: CR2 register.
+ * @arg I2C_Register_OAR1: OAR1 register.
+ * @arg I2C_Register_OAR2: OAR2 register.
+ * @arg I2C_Register_DR: DR register.
+ * @arg I2C_Register_SR1: SR1 register.
+ * @arg I2C_Register_SR2: SR2 register.
+ * @arg I2C_Register_CCR: CCR register.
+ * @arg I2C_Register_TRISE: TRISE register.
+ * @retval The value of the read register.
+ */
+uint16_t I2C_ReadRegister(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint8_t I2C_Register)
+{
+ __IO uint32_t tmp = 0;
+
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_REGISTER(I2C_Register));
+
+ tmp = (uint32_t) I2Cx;
+ tmp += I2C_Register;
+
+ /* Return the selected register value */
+ return (*(__IO uint16_t *) tmp);
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the specified I2C software reset.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the I2C software reset.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void I2C_SoftwareResetCmd(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Peripheral under reset */
+ I2Cx->CR1 |= CR1_SWRST_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Peripheral not under reset */
+ I2Cx->CR1 &= CR1_SWRST_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Drives the SMBusAlert pin high or low for the specified I2C.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param I2C_SMBusAlert: specifies SMBAlert pin level.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg I2C_SMBusAlert_Low: SMBAlert pin driven low
+ * @arg I2C_SMBusAlert_High: SMBAlert pin driven high
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void I2C_SMBusAlertConfig(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint16_t I2C_SMBusAlert)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_SMBUS_ALERT(I2C_SMBusAlert));
+ if (I2C_SMBusAlert == I2C_SMBusAlert_Low)
+ {
+ /* Drive the SMBusAlert pin Low */
+ I2Cx->CR1 |= I2C_SMBusAlert_Low;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Drive the SMBusAlert pin High */
+ I2Cx->CR1 &= I2C_SMBusAlert_High;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the specified I2C PEC transfer.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the I2C PEC transmission.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void I2C_TransmitPEC(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the selected I2C PEC transmission */
+ I2Cx->CR1 |= CR1_PEC_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the selected I2C PEC transmission */
+ I2Cx->CR1 &= CR1_PEC_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Selects the specified I2C PEC position.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param I2C_PECPosition: specifies the PEC position.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg I2C_PECPosition_Next: indicates that the next byte is PEC
+ * @arg I2C_PECPosition_Current: indicates that current byte is PEC
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void I2C_PECPositionConfig(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint16_t I2C_PECPosition)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_PEC_POSITION(I2C_PECPosition));
+ if (I2C_PECPosition == I2C_PECPosition_Next)
+ {
+ /* Next byte in shift register is PEC */
+ I2Cx->CR1 |= I2C_PECPosition_Next;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Current byte in shift register is PEC */
+ I2Cx->CR1 &= I2C_PECPosition_Current;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the PEC value calculation of the transfered bytes.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the I2Cx PEC value calculation.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void I2C_CalculatePEC(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the selected I2C PEC calculation */
+ I2Cx->CR1 |= CR1_ENPEC_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the selected I2C PEC calculation */
+ I2Cx->CR1 &= CR1_ENPEC_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Returns the PEC value for the specified I2C.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @retval The PEC value.
+ */
+uint8_t I2C_GetPEC(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ /* Return the selected I2C PEC value */
+ return ((I2Cx->SR2) >> 8);
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the specified I2C ARP.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the I2Cx ARP.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void I2C_ARPCmd(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the selected I2C ARP */
+ I2Cx->CR1 |= CR1_ENARP_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the selected I2C ARP */
+ I2Cx->CR1 &= CR1_ENARP_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the specified I2C Clock stretching.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the I2Cx Clock stretching.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void I2C_StretchClockCmd(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState == DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the selected I2C Clock stretching */
+ I2Cx->CR1 |= CR1_NOSTRETCH_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the selected I2C Clock stretching */
+ I2Cx->CR1 &= CR1_NOSTRETCH_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Selects the specified I2C fast mode duty cycle.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param I2C_DutyCycle: specifies the fast mode duty cycle.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg I2C_DutyCycle_2: I2C fast mode Tlow/Thigh = 2
+ * @arg I2C_DutyCycle_16_9: I2C fast mode Tlow/Thigh = 16/9
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void I2C_FastModeDutyCycleConfig(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint16_t I2C_DutyCycle)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_DUTY_CYCLE(I2C_DutyCycle));
+ if (I2C_DutyCycle != I2C_DutyCycle_16_9)
+ {
+ /* I2C fast mode Tlow/Thigh=2 */
+ I2Cx->CCR &= I2C_DutyCycle_2;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* I2C fast mode Tlow/Thigh=16/9 */
+ I2Cx->CCR |= I2C_DutyCycle_16_9;
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+/**
+ * @brief
+ ****************************************************************************************
+ *
+ * I2C State Monitoring Functions
+ *
+ ****************************************************************************************
+ * This I2C driver provides three different ways for I2C state monitoring
+ * depending on the application requirements and constraints:
+ *
+ *
+ * 1) Basic state monitoring:
+ * Using I2C_CheckEvent() function:
+ * It compares the status registers (SR1 and SR2) content to a given event
+ * (can be the combination of one or more flags).
+ * It returns SUCCESS if the current status includes the given flags
+ * and returns ERROR if one or more flags are missing in the current status.
+ * - When to use:
+ * - This function is suitable for most applciations as well as for startup
+ * activity since the events are fully described in the product reference manual
+ * (RM0008).
+ * - It is also suitable for users who need to define their own events.
+ * - Limitations:
+ * - If an error occurs (ie. error flags are set besides to the monitored flags),
+ * the I2C_CheckEvent() function may return SUCCESS despite the communication
+ * hold or corrupted real state.
+ * In this case, it is advised to use error interrupts to monitor the error
+ * events and handle them in the interrupt IRQ handler.
+ *
+ * @note
+ * For error management, it is advised to use the following functions:
+ * - I2C_ITConfig() to configure and enable the error interrupts (I2C_IT_ERR).
+ * - I2Cx_ER_IRQHandler() which is called when the error interurpt occurs.
+ * Where x is the peripheral instance (I2C1, I2C2 ...)
+ * - I2C_GetFlagStatus() or I2C_GetITStatus() to be called into I2Cx_ER_IRQHandler()
+ * in order to determine which error occured.
+ * - I2C_ClearFlag() or I2C_ClearITPendingBit() and/or I2C_SoftwareResetCmd()
+ * and/or I2C_GenerateStop() in order to clear the error flag and source,
+ * and return to correct communication status.
+ *
+ *
+ * 2) Advanced state monitoring:
+ * Using the function I2C_GetLastEvent() which returns the image of both status
+ * registers in a single word (uint32_t) (Status Register 2 value is shifted left
+ * by 16 bits and concatenated to Status Register 1).
+ * - When to use:
+ * - This function is suitable for the same applications above but it allows to
+ * overcome the mentionned limitation of I2C_GetFlagStatus() function.
+ * The returned value could be compared to events already defined in the
+ * library (stm32f10x_i2c.h) or to custom values defiend by user.
+ * - This function is suitable when multiple flags are monitored at the same time.
+ * - At the opposite of I2C_CheckEvent() function, this function allows user to
+ * choose when an event is accepted (when all events flags are set and no
+ * other flags are set or just when the needed flags are set like
+ * I2C_CheckEvent() function).
+ * - Limitations:
+ * - User may need to define his own events.
+ * - Same remark concerning the error management is applicable for this
+ * function if user decides to check only regular communication flags (and
+ * ignores error flags).
+ *
+ *
+ * 3) Flag-based state monitoring:
+ * Using the function I2C_GetFlagStatus() which simply returns the status of
+ * one single flag (ie. I2C_FLAG_RXNE ...).
+ * - When to use:
+ * - This function could be used for specific applications or in debug phase.
+ * - It is suitable when only one flag checking is needed (most I2C events
+ * are monitored through multiple flags).
+ * - Limitations:
+ * - When calling this function, the Status register is accessed. Some flags are
+ * cleared when the status register is accessed. So checking the status
+ * of one Flag, may clear other ones.
+ * - Function may need to be called twice or more in order to monitor one
+ * single event.
+ *
+ * For detailed description of Events, please refer to section I2C_Events in
+ * stm32f10x_i2c.h file.
+ *
+ */
+
+/**
+ *
+ * 1) Basic state monitoring
+ *******************************************************************************
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @brief Checks whether the last I2Cx Event is equal to the one passed
+ * as parameter.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param I2C_EVENT: specifies the event to be checked.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_TRANSMITTER_ADDRESS_MATCHED : EV1
+ * @arg I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_RECEIVER_ADDRESS_MATCHED : EV1
+ * @arg I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_TRANSMITTER_SECONDADDRESS_MATCHED : EV1
+ * @arg I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_RECEIVER_SECONDADDRESS_MATCHED : EV1
+ * @arg I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_GENERALCALLADDRESS_MATCHED : EV1
+ * @arg I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_BYTE_RECEIVED : EV2
+ * @arg (I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_BYTE_RECEIVED | I2C_FLAG_DUALF) : EV2
+ * @arg (I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_BYTE_RECEIVED | I2C_FLAG_GENCALL) : EV2
+ * @arg I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_BYTE_TRANSMITTED : EV3
+ * @arg (I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_BYTE_TRANSMITTED | I2C_FLAG_DUALF) : EV3
+ * @arg (I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_BYTE_TRANSMITTED | I2C_FLAG_GENCALL) : EV3
+ * @arg I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_ACK_FAILURE : EV3_2
+ * @arg I2C_EVENT_SLAVE_STOP_DETECTED : EV4
+ * @arg I2C_EVENT_MASTER_MODE_SELECT : EV5
+ * @arg I2C_EVENT_MASTER_TRANSMITTER_MODE_SELECTED : EV6
+ * @arg I2C_EVENT_MASTER_RECEIVER_MODE_SELECTED : EV6
+ * @arg I2C_EVENT_MASTER_BYTE_RECEIVED : EV7
+ * @arg I2C_EVENT_MASTER_BYTE_TRANSMITTING : EV8
+ * @arg I2C_EVENT_MASTER_BYTE_TRANSMITTED : EV8_2
+ * @arg I2C_EVENT_MASTER_MODE_ADDRESS10 : EV9
+ *
+ * @note: For detailed description of Events, please refer to section
+ * I2C_Events in stm32f10x_i2c.h file.
+ *
+ * @retval An ErrorStatus enumuration value:
+ * - SUCCESS: Last event is equal to the I2C_EVENT
+ * - ERROR: Last event is different from the I2C_EVENT
+ */
+ErrorStatus I2C_CheckEvent(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint32_t I2C_EVENT)
+{
+ uint32_t lastevent = 0;
+ uint32_t flag1 = 0, flag2 = 0;
+ ErrorStatus status = ERROR;
+
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_EVENT(I2C_EVENT));
+
+ /* Read the I2Cx status register */
+ flag1 = I2Cx->SR1;
+ flag2 = I2Cx->SR2;
+ flag2 = flag2 << 16;
+
+ /* Get the last event value from I2C status register */
+ lastevent = (flag1 | flag2) & FLAG_Mask;
+
+ /* Check whether the last event contains the I2C_EVENT */
+ if ((lastevent & I2C_EVENT) == I2C_EVENT)
+ {
+ /* SUCCESS: last event is equal to I2C_EVENT */
+ status = SUCCESS;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* ERROR: last event is different from I2C_EVENT */
+ status = ERROR;
+ }
+ /* Return status */
+ return status;
+}
+
+/**
+ *
+ * 2) Advanced state monitoring
+ *******************************************************************************
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @brief Returns the last I2Cx Event.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ *
+ * @note: For detailed description of Events, please refer to section
+ * I2C_Events in stm32f10x_i2c.h file.
+ *
+ * @retval The last event
+ */
+uint32_t I2C_GetLastEvent(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx)
+{
+ uint32_t lastevent = 0;
+ uint32_t flag1 = 0, flag2 = 0;
+
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+
+ /* Read the I2Cx status register */
+ flag1 = I2Cx->SR1;
+ flag2 = I2Cx->SR2;
+ flag2 = flag2 << 16;
+
+ /* Get the last event value from I2C status register */
+ lastevent = (flag1 | flag2) & FLAG_Mask;
+
+ /* Return status */
+ return lastevent;
+}
+
+/**
+ *
+ * 3) Flag-based state monitoring
+ *******************************************************************************
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @brief Checks whether the specified I2C flag is set or not.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param I2C_FLAG: specifies the flag to check.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_DUALF: Dual flag (Slave mode)
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_SMBHOST: SMBus host header (Slave mode)
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_SMBDEFAULT: SMBus default header (Slave mode)
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_GENCALL: General call header flag (Slave mode)
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_TRA: Transmitter/Receiver flag
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_BUSY: Bus busy flag
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_MSL: Master/Slave flag
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_SMBALERT: SMBus Alert flag
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_TIMEOUT: Timeout or Tlow error flag
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_PECERR: PEC error in reception flag
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_OVR: Overrun/Underrun flag (Slave mode)
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_AF: Acknowledge failure flag
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_ARLO: Arbitration lost flag (Master mode)
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_BERR: Bus error flag
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_TXE: Data register empty flag (Transmitter)
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_RXNE: Data register not empty (Receiver) flag
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_STOPF: Stop detection flag (Slave mode)
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_ADD10: 10-bit header sent flag (Master mode)
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_BTF: Byte transfer finished flag
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_ADDR: Address sent flag (Master mode) “ADSL”
+ * Address matched flag (Slave mode)”ENDAD”
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_SB: Start bit flag (Master mode)
+ * @retval The new state of I2C_FLAG (SET or RESET).
+ */
+FlagStatus I2C_GetFlagStatus(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint32_t I2C_FLAG)
+{
+ FlagStatus bitstatus = RESET;
+ __IO uint32_t i2creg = 0, i2cxbase = 0;
+
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_GET_FLAG(I2C_FLAG));
+
+ /* Get the I2Cx peripheral base address */
+ i2cxbase = (uint32_t)I2Cx;
+
+ /* Read flag register index */
+ i2creg = I2C_FLAG >> 28;
+
+ /* Get bit[23:0] of the flag */
+ I2C_FLAG &= FLAG_Mask;
+
+ if(i2creg != 0)
+ {
+ /* Get the I2Cx SR1 register address */
+ i2cxbase += 0x14;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Flag in I2Cx SR2 Register */
+ I2C_FLAG = (uint32_t)(I2C_FLAG >> 16);
+ /* Get the I2Cx SR2 register address */
+ i2cxbase += 0x18;
+ }
+
+ if(((*(__IO uint32_t *)i2cxbase) & I2C_FLAG) != (uint32_t)RESET)
+ {
+ /* I2C_FLAG is set */
+ bitstatus = SET;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* I2C_FLAG is reset */
+ bitstatus = RESET;
+ }
+
+ /* Return the I2C_FLAG status */
+ return bitstatus;
+}
+
+
+
+/**
+ * @brief Clears the I2Cx's pending flags.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param I2C_FLAG: specifies the flag to clear.
+ * This parameter can be any combination of the following values:
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_SMBALERT: SMBus Alert flag
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_TIMEOUT: Timeout or Tlow error flag
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_PECERR: PEC error in reception flag
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_OVR: Overrun/Underrun flag (Slave mode)
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_AF: Acknowledge failure flag
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_ARLO: Arbitration lost flag (Master mode)
+ * @arg I2C_FLAG_BERR: Bus error flag
+ *
+ * @note
+ * - STOPF (STOP detection) is cleared by software sequence: a read operation
+ * to I2C_SR1 register (I2C_GetFlagStatus()) followed by a write operation
+ * to I2C_CR1 register (I2C_Cmd() to re-enable the I2C peripheral).
+ * - ADD10 (10-bit header sent) is cleared by software sequence: a read
+ * operation to I2C_SR1 (I2C_GetFlagStatus()) followed by writing the
+ * second byte of the address in DR register.
+ * - BTF (Byte Transfer Finished) is cleared by software sequence: a read
+ * operation to I2C_SR1 register (I2C_GetFlagStatus()) followed by a
+ * read/write to I2C_DR register (I2C_SendData()).
+ * - ADDR (Address sent) is cleared by software sequence: a read operation to
+ * I2C_SR1 register (I2C_GetFlagStatus()) followed by a read operation to
+ * I2C_SR2 register ((void)(I2Cx->SR2)).
+ * - SB (Start Bit) is cleared software sequence: a read operation to I2C_SR1
+ * register (I2C_GetFlagStatus()) followed by a write operation to I2C_DR
+ * register (I2C_SendData()).
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void I2C_ClearFlag(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint32_t I2C_FLAG)
+{
+ uint32_t flagpos = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_CLEAR_FLAG(I2C_FLAG));
+ /* Get the I2C flag position */
+ flagpos = I2C_FLAG & FLAG_Mask;
+ /* Clear the selected I2C flag */
+ I2Cx->SR1 = (uint16_t)~flagpos;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Checks whether the specified I2C interrupt has occurred or not.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param I2C_IT: specifies the interrupt source to check.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg I2C_IT_SMBALERT: SMBus Alert flag
+ * @arg I2C_IT_TIMEOUT: Timeout or Tlow error flag
+ * @arg I2C_IT_PECERR: PEC error in reception flag
+ * @arg I2C_IT_OVR: Overrun/Underrun flag (Slave mode)
+ * @arg I2C_IT_AF: Acknowledge failure flag
+ * @arg I2C_IT_ARLO: Arbitration lost flag (Master mode)
+ * @arg I2C_IT_BERR: Bus error flag
+ * @arg I2C_IT_TXE: Data register empty flag (Transmitter)
+ * @arg I2C_IT_RXNE: Data register not empty (Receiver) flag
+ * @arg I2C_IT_STOPF: Stop detection flag (Slave mode)
+ * @arg I2C_IT_ADD10: 10-bit header sent flag (Master mode)
+ * @arg I2C_IT_BTF: Byte transfer finished flag
+ * @arg I2C_IT_ADDR: Address sent flag (Master mode) “ADSL”
+ * Address matched flag (Slave mode)”ENDAD”
+ * @arg I2C_IT_SB: Start bit flag (Master mode)
+ * @retval The new state of I2C_IT (SET or RESET).
+ */
+ITStatus I2C_GetITStatus(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint32_t I2C_IT)
+{
+ ITStatus bitstatus = RESET;
+ uint32_t enablestatus = 0;
+
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_GET_IT(I2C_IT));
+
+ /* Check if the interrupt source is enabled or not */
+ enablestatus = (uint32_t)(((I2C_IT & ITEN_Mask) >> 16) & (I2Cx->CR2)) ;
+
+ /* Get bit[23:0] of the flag */
+ I2C_IT &= FLAG_Mask;
+
+ /* Check the status of the specified I2C flag */
+ if (((I2Cx->SR1 & I2C_IT) != (uint32_t)RESET) && enablestatus)
+ {
+ /* I2C_IT is set */
+ bitstatus = SET;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* I2C_IT is reset */
+ bitstatus = RESET;
+ }
+ /* Return the I2C_IT status */
+ return bitstatus;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Clears the I2Cx’s interrupt pending bits.
+ * @param I2Cx: where x can be 1 or 2 to select the I2C peripheral.
+ * @param I2C_IT: specifies the interrupt pending bit to clear.
+ * This parameter can be any combination of the following values:
+ * @arg I2C_IT_SMBALERT: SMBus Alert interrupt
+ * @arg I2C_IT_TIMEOUT: Timeout or Tlow error interrupt
+ * @arg I2C_IT_PECERR: PEC error in reception interrupt
+ * @arg I2C_IT_OVR: Overrun/Underrun interrupt (Slave mode)
+ * @arg I2C_IT_AF: Acknowledge failure interrupt
+ * @arg I2C_IT_ARLO: Arbitration lost interrupt (Master mode)
+ * @arg I2C_IT_BERR: Bus error interrupt
+ *
+ * @note
+ * - STOPF (STOP detection) is cleared by software sequence: a read operation
+ * to I2C_SR1 register (I2C_GetITStatus()) followed by a write operation to
+ * I2C_CR1 register (I2C_Cmd() to re-enable the I2C peripheral).
+ * - ADD10 (10-bit header sent) is cleared by software sequence: a read
+ * operation to I2C_SR1 (I2C_GetITStatus()) followed by writing the second
+ * byte of the address in I2C_DR register.
+ * - BTF (Byte Transfer Finished) is cleared by software sequence: a read
+ * operation to I2C_SR1 register (I2C_GetITStatus()) followed by a
+ * read/write to I2C_DR register (I2C_SendData()).
+ * - ADDR (Address sent) is cleared by software sequence: a read operation to
+ * I2C_SR1 register (I2C_GetITStatus()) followed by a read operation to
+ * I2C_SR2 register ((void)(I2Cx->SR2)).
+ * - SB (Start Bit) is cleared by software sequence: a read operation to
+ * I2C_SR1 register (I2C_GetITStatus()) followed by a write operation to
+ * I2C_DR register (I2C_SendData()).
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void I2C_ClearITPendingBit(I2C_TypeDef* I2Cx, uint32_t I2C_IT)
+{
+ uint32_t flagpos = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_ALL_PERIPH(I2Cx));
+ assert_param(IS_I2C_CLEAR_IT(I2C_IT));
+ /* Get the I2C flag position */
+ flagpos = I2C_IT & FLAG_Mask;
+ /* Clear the selected I2C flag */
+ I2Cx->SR1 = (uint16_t)~flagpos;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/******************* (C) COPYRIGHT 2010 STMicroelectronics *****END OF FILE****/
diff --git a/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Libraries/STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver/src/stm32f10x_iwdg.c b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Libraries/STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver/src/stm32f10x_iwdg.c
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..7738cf3c4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Libraries/STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver/src/stm32f10x_iwdg.c
@@ -0,0 +1,189 @@
+/**
+ ******************************************************************************
+ * @file stm32f10x_iwdg.c
+ * @author MCD Application Team
+ * @version V3.4.0
+ * @date 10/15/2010
+ * @brief This file provides all the IWDG firmware functions.
+ ******************************************************************************
+ * @copy
+ *
+ * THE PRESENT FIRMWARE WHICH IS FOR GUIDANCE ONLY AIMS AT PROVIDING CUSTOMERS
+ * WITH CODING INFORMATION REGARDING THEIR PRODUCTS IN ORDER FOR THEM TO SAVE
+ * TIME. AS A RESULT, STMICROELECTRONICS SHALL NOT BE HELD LIABLE FOR ANY
+ * DIRECT, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES WITH RESPECT TO ANY CLAIMS ARISING
+ * FROM THE CONTENT OF SUCH FIRMWARE AND/OR THE USE MADE BY CUSTOMERS OF THE
+ * CODING INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN IN CONNECTION WITH THEIR PRODUCTS.
+ *
+ *
+ */
+
+/* Includes ------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+#include "stm32f10x_tim.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_rcc.h"
+
+/** @addtogroup STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup TIM
+ * @brief TIM driver modules
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup TIM_Private_TypesDefinitions
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup TIM_Private_Defines
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/* ---------------------- TIM registers bit mask ------------------------ */
+#define SMCR_ETR_Mask ((uint16_t)0x00FF)
+#define CCMR_Offset ((uint16_t)0x0018)
+#define CCER_CCE_Set ((uint16_t)0x0001)
+#define CCER_CCNE_Set ((uint16_t)0x0004)
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup TIM_Private_Macros
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup TIM_Private_Variables
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup TIM_Private_FunctionPrototypes
+ * @{
+ */
+
+static void TI1_Config(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_ICPolarity, uint16_t TIM_ICSelection,
+ uint16_t TIM_ICFilter);
+static void TI2_Config(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_ICPolarity, uint16_t TIM_ICSelection,
+ uint16_t TIM_ICFilter);
+static void TI3_Config(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_ICPolarity, uint16_t TIM_ICSelection,
+ uint16_t TIM_ICFilter);
+static void TI4_Config(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_ICPolarity, uint16_t TIM_ICSelection,
+ uint16_t TIM_ICFilter);
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup TIM_Private_Macros
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup TIM_Private_Variables
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup TIM_Private_FunctionPrototypes
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup TIM_Private_Functions
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @brief Deinitializes the TIMx peripheral registers to their default reset values.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_DeInit(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_ALL_PERIPH(TIMx));
+
+ if (TIMx == TIM1)
+ {
+ RCC_APB2PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB2Periph_TIM1, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB2PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB2Periph_TIM1, DISABLE);
+ }
+ else if (TIMx == TIM2)
+ {
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_TIM2, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_TIM2, DISABLE);
+ }
+ else if (TIMx == TIM3)
+ {
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_TIM3, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_TIM3, DISABLE);
+ }
+ else if (TIMx == TIM4)
+ {
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_TIM4, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_TIM4, DISABLE);
+ }
+ else if (TIMx == TIM5)
+ {
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_TIM5, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_TIM5, DISABLE);
+ }
+ else if (TIMx == TIM6)
+ {
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_TIM6, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_TIM6, DISABLE);
+ }
+ else if (TIMx == TIM7)
+ {
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_TIM7, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_TIM7, DISABLE);
+ }
+ else if (TIMx == TIM8)
+ {
+ RCC_APB2PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB2Periph_TIM8, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB2PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB2Periph_TIM8, DISABLE);
+ }
+ else if (TIMx == TIM9)
+ {
+ RCC_APB2PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB2Periph_TIM9, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB2PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB2Periph_TIM9, DISABLE);
+ }
+ else if (TIMx == TIM10)
+ {
+ RCC_APB2PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB2Periph_TIM10, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB2PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB2Periph_TIM10, DISABLE);
+ }
+ else if (TIMx == TIM11)
+ {
+ RCC_APB2PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB2Periph_TIM11, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB2PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB2Periph_TIM11, DISABLE);
+ }
+ else if (TIMx == TIM12)
+ {
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_TIM12, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_TIM12, DISABLE);
+ }
+ else if (TIMx == TIM13)
+ {
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_TIM13, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_TIM13, DISABLE);
+ }
+ else if (TIMx == TIM14)
+ {
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_TIM14, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_TIM14, DISABLE);
+ }
+ else if (TIMx == TIM15)
+ {
+ RCC_APB2PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB2Periph_TIM15, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB2PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB2Periph_TIM15, DISABLE);
+ }
+ else if (TIMx == TIM16)
+ {
+ RCC_APB2PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB2Periph_TIM16, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB2PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB2Periph_TIM16, DISABLE);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if (TIMx == TIM17)
+ {
+ RCC_APB2PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB2Periph_TIM17, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB2PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB2Periph_TIM17, DISABLE);
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Initializes the TIMx Time Base Unit peripheral according to
+ * the specified parameters in the TIM_TimeBaseInitStruct.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_TimeBaseInitStruct: pointer to a TIM_TimeBaseInitTypeDef
+ * structure that contains the configuration information for the specified TIM peripheral.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_TimeBaseInit(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, TIM_TimeBaseInitTypeDef* TIM_TimeBaseInitStruct)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpcr1 = 0;
+
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_ALL_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_COUNTER_MODE(TIM_TimeBaseInitStruct->TIM_CounterMode));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_CKD_DIV(TIM_TimeBaseInitStruct->TIM_ClockDivision));
+
+ tmpcr1 = TIMx->CR1;
+
+ if((TIMx == TIM1) || (TIMx == TIM8)|| (TIMx == TIM2) || (TIMx == TIM3)||
+ (TIMx == TIM4) || (TIMx == TIM5))
+ {
+ /* Select the Counter Mode */
+ tmpcr1 &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)(TIM_CR1_DIR | TIM_CR1_CMS)));
+ tmpcr1 |= (uint32_t)TIM_TimeBaseInitStruct->TIM_CounterMode;
+ }
+
+ if((TIMx != TIM6) && (TIMx != TIM7))
+ {
+ /* Set the clock division */
+ tmpcr1 &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CR1_CKD));
+ tmpcr1 |= (uint32_t)TIM_TimeBaseInitStruct->TIM_ClockDivision;
+ }
+
+ TIMx->CR1 = tmpcr1;
+
+ /* Set the Autoreload value */
+ TIMx->ARR = TIM_TimeBaseInitStruct->TIM_Period ;
+
+ /* Set the Prescaler value */
+ TIMx->PSC = TIM_TimeBaseInitStruct->TIM_Prescaler;
+
+ if ((TIMx == TIM1) || (TIMx == TIM8)|| (TIMx == TIM15)|| (TIMx == TIM16) || (TIMx == TIM17))
+ {
+ /* Set the Repetition Counter value */
+ TIMx->RCR = TIM_TimeBaseInitStruct->TIM_RepetitionCounter;
+ }
+
+ /* Generate an update event to reload the Prescaler and the Repetition counter
+ values immediately */
+ TIMx->EGR = TIM_PSCReloadMode_Immediate;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Initializes the TIMx Channel1 according to the specified
+ * parameters in the TIM_OCInitStruct.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 except 6 and 7 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCInitStruct: pointer to a TIM_OCInitTypeDef structure
+ * that contains the configuration information for the specified TIM peripheral.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_OC1Init(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, TIM_OCInitTypeDef* TIM_OCInitStruct)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmrx = 0, tmpccer = 0, tmpcr2 = 0;
+
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST8_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OC_MODE(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCMode));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OUTPUT_STATE(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OutputState));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OC_POLARITY(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCPolarity));
+ /* Disable the Channel 1: Reset the CC1E Bit */
+ TIMx->CCER &= (uint16_t)(~(uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC1E);
+ /* Get the TIMx CCER register value */
+ tmpccer = TIMx->CCER;
+ /* Get the TIMx CR2 register value */
+ tmpcr2 = TIMx->CR2;
+
+ /* Get the TIMx CCMR1 register value */
+ tmpccmrx = TIMx->CCMR1;
+
+ /* Reset the Output Compare Mode Bits */
+ tmpccmrx &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR1_OC1M));
+ tmpccmrx &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR1_CC1S));
+
+ /* Select the Output Compare Mode */
+ tmpccmrx |= TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCMode;
+
+ /* Reset the Output Polarity level */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC1P));
+ /* Set the Output Compare Polarity */
+ tmpccer |= TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCPolarity;
+
+ /* Set the Output State */
+ tmpccer |= TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OutputState;
+
+ if((TIMx == TIM1) || (TIMx == TIM8)|| (TIMx == TIM15)||
+ (TIMx == TIM16)|| (TIMx == TIM17))
+ {
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OUTPUTN_STATE(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OutputNState));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCN_POLARITY(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCNPolarity));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCNIDLE_STATE(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCNIdleState));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCIDLE_STATE(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCIdleState));
+
+ /* Reset the Output N Polarity level */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC1NP));
+ /* Set the Output N Polarity */
+ tmpccer |= TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCNPolarity;
+
+ /* Reset the Output N State */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC1NE));
+ /* Set the Output N State */
+ tmpccer |= TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OutputNState;
+
+ /* Reset the Ouput Compare and Output Compare N IDLE State */
+ tmpcr2 &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CR2_OIS1));
+ tmpcr2 &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CR2_OIS1N));
+
+ /* Set the Output Idle state */
+ tmpcr2 |= TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCIdleState;
+ /* Set the Output N Idle state */
+ tmpcr2 |= TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCNIdleState;
+ }
+ /* Write to TIMx CR2 */
+ TIMx->CR2 = tmpcr2;
+
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR1 */
+ TIMx->CCMR1 = tmpccmrx;
+
+ /* Set the Capture Compare Register value */
+ TIMx->CCR1 = TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_Pulse;
+
+ /* Write to TIMx CCER */
+ TIMx->CCER = tmpccer;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Initializes the TIMx Channel2 according to the specified
+ * parameters in the TIM_OCInitStruct.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 8, 9, 12 or 15 to select
+ * the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCInitStruct: pointer to a TIM_OCInitTypeDef structure
+ * that contains the configuration information for the specified TIM peripheral.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_OC2Init(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, TIM_OCInitTypeDef* TIM_OCInitStruct)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmrx = 0, tmpccer = 0, tmpcr2 = 0;
+
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST6_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OC_MODE(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCMode));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OUTPUT_STATE(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OutputState));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OC_POLARITY(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCPolarity));
+ /* Disable the Channel 2: Reset the CC2E Bit */
+ TIMx->CCER &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC2E));
+
+ /* Get the TIMx CCER register value */
+ tmpccer = TIMx->CCER;
+ /* Get the TIMx CR2 register value */
+ tmpcr2 = TIMx->CR2;
+
+ /* Get the TIMx CCMR1 register value */
+ tmpccmrx = TIMx->CCMR1;
+
+ /* Reset the Output Compare mode and Capture/Compare selection Bits */
+ tmpccmrx &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR1_OC2M));
+ tmpccmrx &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR1_CC2S));
+
+ /* Select the Output Compare Mode */
+ tmpccmrx |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCMode << 8);
+
+ /* Reset the Output Polarity level */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC2P));
+ /* Set the Output Compare Polarity */
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCPolarity << 4);
+
+ /* Set the Output State */
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OutputState << 4);
+
+ if((TIMx == TIM1) || (TIMx == TIM8))
+ {
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OUTPUTN_STATE(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OutputNState));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCN_POLARITY(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCNPolarity));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCNIDLE_STATE(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCNIdleState));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCIDLE_STATE(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCIdleState));
+
+ /* Reset the Output N Polarity level */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC2NP));
+ /* Set the Output N Polarity */
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCNPolarity << 4);
+
+ /* Reset the Output N State */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC2NE));
+ /* Set the Output N State */
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OutputNState << 4);
+
+ /* Reset the Ouput Compare and Output Compare N IDLE State */
+ tmpcr2 &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CR2_OIS2));
+ tmpcr2 &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CR2_OIS2N));
+
+ /* Set the Output Idle state */
+ tmpcr2 |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCIdleState << 2);
+ /* Set the Output N Idle state */
+ tmpcr2 |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCNIdleState << 2);
+ }
+ /* Write to TIMx CR2 */
+ TIMx->CR2 = tmpcr2;
+
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR1 */
+ TIMx->CCMR1 = tmpccmrx;
+
+ /* Set the Capture Compare Register value */
+ TIMx->CCR2 = TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_Pulse;
+
+ /* Write to TIMx CCER */
+ TIMx->CCER = tmpccer;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Initializes the TIMx Channel3 according to the specified
+ * parameters in the TIM_OCInitStruct.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCInitStruct: pointer to a TIM_OCInitTypeDef structure
+ * that contains the configuration information for the specified TIM peripheral.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_OC3Init(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, TIM_OCInitTypeDef* TIM_OCInitStruct)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmrx = 0, tmpccer = 0, tmpcr2 = 0;
+
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OC_MODE(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCMode));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OUTPUT_STATE(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OutputState));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OC_POLARITY(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCPolarity));
+ /* Disable the Channel 2: Reset the CC2E Bit */
+ TIMx->CCER &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC3E));
+
+ /* Get the TIMx CCER register value */
+ tmpccer = TIMx->CCER;
+ /* Get the TIMx CR2 register value */
+ tmpcr2 = TIMx->CR2;
+
+ /* Get the TIMx CCMR2 register value */
+ tmpccmrx = TIMx->CCMR2;
+
+ /* Reset the Output Compare mode and Capture/Compare selection Bits */
+ tmpccmrx &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR2_OC3M));
+ tmpccmrx &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR2_CC3S));
+ /* Select the Output Compare Mode */
+ tmpccmrx |= TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCMode;
+
+ /* Reset the Output Polarity level */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC3P));
+ /* Set the Output Compare Polarity */
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCPolarity << 8);
+
+ /* Set the Output State */
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OutputState << 8);
+
+ if((TIMx == TIM1) || (TIMx == TIM8))
+ {
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OUTPUTN_STATE(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OutputNState));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCN_POLARITY(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCNPolarity));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCNIDLE_STATE(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCNIdleState));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCIDLE_STATE(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCIdleState));
+
+ /* Reset the Output N Polarity level */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC3NP));
+ /* Set the Output N Polarity */
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCNPolarity << 8);
+ /* Reset the Output N State */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC3NE));
+
+ /* Set the Output N State */
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OutputNState << 8);
+ /* Reset the Ouput Compare and Output Compare N IDLE State */
+ tmpcr2 &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CR2_OIS3));
+ tmpcr2 &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CR2_OIS3N));
+ /* Set the Output Idle state */
+ tmpcr2 |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCIdleState << 4);
+ /* Set the Output N Idle state */
+ tmpcr2 |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCNIdleState << 4);
+ }
+ /* Write to TIMx CR2 */
+ TIMx->CR2 = tmpcr2;
+
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR2 */
+ TIMx->CCMR2 = tmpccmrx;
+
+ /* Set the Capture Compare Register value */
+ TIMx->CCR3 = TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_Pulse;
+
+ /* Write to TIMx CCER */
+ TIMx->CCER = tmpccer;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Initializes the TIMx Channel4 according to the specified
+ * parameters in the TIM_OCInitStruct.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCInitStruct: pointer to a TIM_OCInitTypeDef structure
+ * that contains the configuration information for the specified TIM peripheral.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_OC4Init(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, TIM_OCInitTypeDef* TIM_OCInitStruct)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmrx = 0, tmpccer = 0, tmpcr2 = 0;
+
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OC_MODE(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCMode));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OUTPUT_STATE(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OutputState));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OC_POLARITY(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCPolarity));
+ /* Disable the Channel 2: Reset the CC4E Bit */
+ TIMx->CCER &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC4E));
+
+ /* Get the TIMx CCER register value */
+ tmpccer = TIMx->CCER;
+ /* Get the TIMx CR2 register value */
+ tmpcr2 = TIMx->CR2;
+
+ /* Get the TIMx CCMR2 register value */
+ tmpccmrx = TIMx->CCMR2;
+
+ /* Reset the Output Compare mode and Capture/Compare selection Bits */
+ tmpccmrx &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR2_OC4M));
+ tmpccmrx &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR2_CC4S));
+
+ /* Select the Output Compare Mode */
+ tmpccmrx |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCMode << 8);
+
+ /* Reset the Output Polarity level */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC4P));
+ /* Set the Output Compare Polarity */
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCPolarity << 12);
+
+ /* Set the Output State */
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OutputState << 12);
+
+ if((TIMx == TIM1) || (TIMx == TIM8))
+ {
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCIDLE_STATE(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCIdleState));
+ /* Reset the Ouput Compare IDLE State */
+ tmpcr2 &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CR2_OIS4));
+ /* Set the Output Idle state */
+ tmpcr2 |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCIdleState << 6);
+ }
+ /* Write to TIMx CR2 */
+ TIMx->CR2 = tmpcr2;
+
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR2 */
+ TIMx->CCMR2 = tmpccmrx;
+
+ /* Set the Capture Compare Register value */
+ TIMx->CCR4 = TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_Pulse;
+
+ /* Write to TIMx CCER */
+ TIMx->CCER = tmpccer;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Initializes the TIM peripheral according to the specified
+ * parameters in the TIM_ICInitStruct.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 except 6 and 7 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_ICInitStruct: pointer to a TIM_ICInitTypeDef structure
+ * that contains the configuration information for the specified TIM peripheral.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_ICInit(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, TIM_ICInitTypeDef* TIM_ICInitStruct)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_CHANNEL(TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_Channel));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_IC_SELECTION(TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICSelection));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_IC_PRESCALER(TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICPrescaler));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_IC_FILTER(TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICFilter));
+
+ if((TIMx == TIM1) || (TIMx == TIM8) || (TIMx == TIM2) || (TIMx == TIM3) ||
+ (TIMx == TIM4) ||(TIMx == TIM5))
+ {
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_IC_POLARITY(TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICPolarity));
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_IC_POLARITY_LITE(TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICPolarity));
+ }
+ if (TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_Channel == TIM_Channel_1)
+ {
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST8_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ /* TI1 Configuration */
+ TI1_Config(TIMx, TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICPolarity,
+ TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICSelection,
+ TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICFilter);
+ /* Set the Input Capture Prescaler value */
+ TIM_SetIC1Prescaler(TIMx, TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICPrescaler);
+ }
+ else if (TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_Channel == TIM_Channel_2)
+ {
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST6_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ /* TI2 Configuration */
+ TI2_Config(TIMx, TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICPolarity,
+ TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICSelection,
+ TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICFilter);
+ /* Set the Input Capture Prescaler value */
+ TIM_SetIC2Prescaler(TIMx, TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICPrescaler);
+ }
+ else if (TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_Channel == TIM_Channel_3)
+ {
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ /* TI3 Configuration */
+ TI3_Config(TIMx, TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICPolarity,
+ TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICSelection,
+ TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICFilter);
+ /* Set the Input Capture Prescaler value */
+ TIM_SetIC3Prescaler(TIMx, TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICPrescaler);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ /* TI4 Configuration */
+ TI4_Config(TIMx, TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICPolarity,
+ TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICSelection,
+ TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICFilter);
+ /* Set the Input Capture Prescaler value */
+ TIM_SetIC4Prescaler(TIMx, TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICPrescaler);
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the TIM peripheral according to the specified
+ * parameters in the TIM_ICInitStruct to measure an external PWM signal.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 8, 9, 12 or 15 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_ICInitStruct: pointer to a TIM_ICInitTypeDef structure
+ * that contains the configuration information for the specified TIM peripheral.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_PWMIConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, TIM_ICInitTypeDef* TIM_ICInitStruct)
+{
+ uint16_t icoppositepolarity = TIM_ICPolarity_Rising;
+ uint16_t icoppositeselection = TIM_ICSelection_DirectTI;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST6_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ /* Select the Opposite Input Polarity */
+ if (TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICPolarity == TIM_ICPolarity_Rising)
+ {
+ icoppositepolarity = TIM_ICPolarity_Falling;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ icoppositepolarity = TIM_ICPolarity_Rising;
+ }
+ /* Select the Opposite Input */
+ if (TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICSelection == TIM_ICSelection_DirectTI)
+ {
+ icoppositeselection = TIM_ICSelection_IndirectTI;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ icoppositeselection = TIM_ICSelection_DirectTI;
+ }
+ if (TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_Channel == TIM_Channel_1)
+ {
+ /* TI1 Configuration */
+ TI1_Config(TIMx, TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICPolarity, TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICSelection,
+ TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICFilter);
+ /* Set the Input Capture Prescaler value */
+ TIM_SetIC1Prescaler(TIMx, TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICPrescaler);
+ /* TI2 Configuration */
+ TI2_Config(TIMx, icoppositepolarity, icoppositeselection, TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICFilter);
+ /* Set the Input Capture Prescaler value */
+ TIM_SetIC2Prescaler(TIMx, TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICPrescaler);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* TI2 Configuration */
+ TI2_Config(TIMx, TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICPolarity, TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICSelection,
+ TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICFilter);
+ /* Set the Input Capture Prescaler value */
+ TIM_SetIC2Prescaler(TIMx, TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICPrescaler);
+ /* TI1 Configuration */
+ TI1_Config(TIMx, icoppositepolarity, icoppositeselection, TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICFilter);
+ /* Set the Input Capture Prescaler value */
+ TIM_SetIC1Prescaler(TIMx, TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICPrescaler);
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the: Break feature, dead time, Lock level, the OSSI,
+ * the OSSR State and the AOE(automatic output enable).
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 or 8 to select the TIM
+ * @param TIM_BDTRInitStruct: pointer to a TIM_BDTRInitTypeDef structure that
+ * contains the BDTR Register configuration information for the TIM peripheral.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_BDTRConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, TIM_BDTRInitTypeDef *TIM_BDTRInitStruct)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST2_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OSSR_STATE(TIM_BDTRInitStruct->TIM_OSSRState));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OSSI_STATE(TIM_BDTRInitStruct->TIM_OSSIState));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LOCK_LEVEL(TIM_BDTRInitStruct->TIM_LOCKLevel));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_BREAK_STATE(TIM_BDTRInitStruct->TIM_Break));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_BREAK_POLARITY(TIM_BDTRInitStruct->TIM_BreakPolarity));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_AUTOMATIC_OUTPUT_STATE(TIM_BDTRInitStruct->TIM_AutomaticOutput));
+ /* Set the Lock level, the Break enable Bit and the Ploarity, the OSSR State,
+ the OSSI State, the dead time value and the Automatic Output Enable Bit */
+ TIMx->BDTR = (uint32_t)TIM_BDTRInitStruct->TIM_OSSRState | TIM_BDTRInitStruct->TIM_OSSIState |
+ TIM_BDTRInitStruct->TIM_LOCKLevel | TIM_BDTRInitStruct->TIM_DeadTime |
+ TIM_BDTRInitStruct->TIM_Break | TIM_BDTRInitStruct->TIM_BreakPolarity |
+ TIM_BDTRInitStruct->TIM_AutomaticOutput;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Fills each TIM_TimeBaseInitStruct member with its default value.
+ * @param TIM_TimeBaseInitStruct : pointer to a TIM_TimeBaseInitTypeDef
+ * structure which will be initialized.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_TimeBaseStructInit(TIM_TimeBaseInitTypeDef* TIM_TimeBaseInitStruct)
+{
+ /* Set the default configuration */
+ TIM_TimeBaseInitStruct->TIM_Period = 0xFFFF;
+ TIM_TimeBaseInitStruct->TIM_Prescaler = 0x0000;
+ TIM_TimeBaseInitStruct->TIM_ClockDivision = TIM_CKD_DIV1;
+ TIM_TimeBaseInitStruct->TIM_CounterMode = TIM_CounterMode_Up;
+ TIM_TimeBaseInitStruct->TIM_RepetitionCounter = 0x0000;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Fills each TIM_OCInitStruct member with its default value.
+ * @param TIM_OCInitStruct : pointer to a TIM_OCInitTypeDef structure which will
+ * be initialized.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_OCStructInit(TIM_OCInitTypeDef* TIM_OCInitStruct)
+{
+ /* Set the default configuration */
+ TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCMode = TIM_OCMode_Timing;
+ TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OutputState = TIM_OutputState_Disable;
+ TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OutputNState = TIM_OutputNState_Disable;
+ TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_Pulse = 0x0000;
+ TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCPolarity = TIM_OCPolarity_High;
+ TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCNPolarity = TIM_OCPolarity_High;
+ TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCIdleState = TIM_OCIdleState_Reset;
+ TIM_OCInitStruct->TIM_OCNIdleState = TIM_OCNIdleState_Reset;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Fills each TIM_ICInitStruct member with its default value.
+ * @param TIM_ICInitStruct : pointer to a TIM_ICInitTypeDef structure which will
+ * be initialized.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_ICStructInit(TIM_ICInitTypeDef* TIM_ICInitStruct)
+{
+ /* Set the default configuration */
+ TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_Channel = TIM_Channel_1;
+ TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICPolarity = TIM_ICPolarity_Rising;
+ TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICSelection = TIM_ICSelection_DirectTI;
+ TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICPrescaler = TIM_ICPSC_DIV1;
+ TIM_ICInitStruct->TIM_ICFilter = 0x00;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Fills each TIM_BDTRInitStruct member with its default value.
+ * @param TIM_BDTRInitStruct: pointer to a TIM_BDTRInitTypeDef structure which
+ * will be initialized.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_BDTRStructInit(TIM_BDTRInitTypeDef* TIM_BDTRInitStruct)
+{
+ /* Set the default configuration */
+ TIM_BDTRInitStruct->TIM_OSSRState = TIM_OSSRState_Disable;
+ TIM_BDTRInitStruct->TIM_OSSIState = TIM_OSSIState_Disable;
+ TIM_BDTRInitStruct->TIM_LOCKLevel = TIM_LOCKLevel_OFF;
+ TIM_BDTRInitStruct->TIM_DeadTime = 0x00;
+ TIM_BDTRInitStruct->TIM_Break = TIM_Break_Disable;
+ TIM_BDTRInitStruct->TIM_BreakPolarity = TIM_BreakPolarity_Low;
+ TIM_BDTRInitStruct->TIM_AutomaticOutput = TIM_AutomaticOutput_Disable;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the specified TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 to select the TIMx peripheral.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the TIMx peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_Cmd(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_ALL_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the TIM Counter */
+ TIMx->CR1 |= TIM_CR1_CEN;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the TIM Counter */
+ TIMx->CR1 &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CR1_CEN));
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the TIM peripheral Main Outputs.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 8, 15, 16 or 17 to select the TIMx peripheral.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the TIM peripheral Main Outputs.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_CtrlPWMOutputs(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST2_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the TIM Main Output */
+ TIMx->BDTR |= TIM_BDTR_MOE;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the TIM Main Output */
+ TIMx->BDTR &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_BDTR_MOE));
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the specified TIM interrupts.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 to select the TIMx peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_IT: specifies the TIM interrupts sources to be enabled or disabled.
+ * This parameter can be any combination of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_IT_Update: TIM update Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_IT_CC1: TIM Capture Compare 1 Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_IT_CC2: TIM Capture Compare 2 Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_IT_CC3: TIM Capture Compare 3 Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_IT_CC4: TIM Capture Compare 4 Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_IT_COM: TIM Commutation Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_IT_Trigger: TIM Trigger Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_IT_Break: TIM Break Interrupt source
+ * @note
+ * - TIM6 and TIM7 can only generate an update interrupt.
+ * - TIM9, TIM12 and TIM15 can have only TIM_IT_Update, TIM_IT_CC1,
+ * TIM_IT_CC2 or TIM_IT_Trigger.
+ * - TIM10, TIM11, TIM13, TIM14, TIM16 and TIM17 can have TIM_IT_Update or TIM_IT_CC1.
+ * - TIM_IT_Break is used only with TIM1, TIM8 and TIM15.
+ * - TIM_IT_COM is used only with TIM1, TIM8, TIM15, TIM16 and TIM17.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the TIM interrupts.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_ITConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_IT, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_ALL_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_IT(TIM_IT));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the Interrupt sources */
+ TIMx->DIER |= TIM_IT;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the Interrupt sources */
+ TIMx->DIER &= (uint16_t)~TIM_IT;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the TIMx event to be generate by software.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_EventSource: specifies the event source.
+ * This parameter can be one or more of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_EventSource_Update: Timer update Event source
+ * @arg TIM_EventSource_CC1: Timer Capture Compare 1 Event source
+ * @arg TIM_EventSource_CC2: Timer Capture Compare 2 Event source
+ * @arg TIM_EventSource_CC3: Timer Capture Compare 3 Event source
+ * @arg TIM_EventSource_CC4: Timer Capture Compare 4 Event source
+ * @arg TIM_EventSource_COM: Timer COM event source
+ * @arg TIM_EventSource_Trigger: Timer Trigger Event source
+ * @arg TIM_EventSource_Break: Timer Break event source
+ * @note
+ * - TIM6 and TIM7 can only generate an update event.
+ * - TIM_EventSource_COM and TIM_EventSource_Break are used only with TIM1 and TIM8.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_GenerateEvent(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_EventSource)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_ALL_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_EVENT_SOURCE(TIM_EventSource));
+
+ /* Set the event sources */
+ TIMx->EGR = TIM_EventSource;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the TIMx’s DMA interface.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 8, 15, 16 or 17 to select
+ * the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_DMABase: DMA Base address.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_DMABase_CR, TIM_DMABase_CR2, TIM_DMABase_SMCR,
+ * TIM_DMABase_DIER, TIM1_DMABase_SR, TIM_DMABase_EGR,
+ * TIM_DMABase_CCMR1, TIM_DMABase_CCMR2, TIM_DMABase_CCER,
+ * TIM_DMABase_CNT, TIM_DMABase_PSC, TIM_DMABase_ARR,
+ * TIM_DMABase_RCR, TIM_DMABase_CCR1, TIM_DMABase_CCR2,
+ * TIM_DMABase_CCR3, TIM_DMABase_CCR4, TIM_DMABase_BDTR,
+ * TIM_DMABase_DCR.
+ * @param TIM_DMABurstLength: DMA Burst length.
+ * This parameter can be one value between:
+ * TIM_DMABurstLength_1Byte and TIM_DMABurstLength_18Bytes.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_DMAConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_DMABase, uint16_t TIM_DMABurstLength)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST4_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_DMA_BASE(TIM_DMABase));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_DMA_LENGTH(TIM_DMABurstLength));
+ /* Set the DMA Base and the DMA Burst Length */
+ TIMx->DCR = TIM_DMABase | TIM_DMABurstLength;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the TIMx’s DMA Requests.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 15, 16 or 17
+ * to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_DMASource: specifies the DMA Request sources.
+ * This parameter can be any combination of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_DMA_Update: TIM update Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_DMA_CC1: TIM Capture Compare 1 DMA source
+ * @arg TIM_DMA_CC2: TIM Capture Compare 2 DMA source
+ * @arg TIM_DMA_CC3: TIM Capture Compare 3 DMA source
+ * @arg TIM_DMA_CC4: TIM Capture Compare 4 DMA source
+ * @arg TIM_DMA_COM: TIM Commutation DMA source
+ * @arg TIM_DMA_Trigger: TIM Trigger DMA source
+ * @param NewState: new state of the DMA Request sources.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_DMACmd(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_DMASource, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST9_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_DMA_SOURCE(TIM_DMASource));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the DMA sources */
+ TIMx->DIER |= TIM_DMASource;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the DMA sources */
+ TIMx->DIER &= (uint16_t)~TIM_DMASource;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the TIMx interrnal Clock
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 8, 9, 12 or 15
+ * to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_InternalClockConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST6_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ /* Disable slave mode to clock the prescaler directly with the internal clock */
+ TIMx->SMCR &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_SMCR_SMS));
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the TIMx Internal Trigger as External Clock
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 9, 12 or 15 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_ITRSource: Trigger source.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @param TIM_TS_ITR0: Internal Trigger 0
+ * @param TIM_TS_ITR1: Internal Trigger 1
+ * @param TIM_TS_ITR2: Internal Trigger 2
+ * @param TIM_TS_ITR3: Internal Trigger 3
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_ITRxExternalClockConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_InputTriggerSource)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST6_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_INTERNAL_TRIGGER_SELECTION(TIM_InputTriggerSource));
+ /* Select the Internal Trigger */
+ TIM_SelectInputTrigger(TIMx, TIM_InputTriggerSource);
+ /* Select the External clock mode1 */
+ TIMx->SMCR |= TIM_SlaveMode_External1;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the TIMx Trigger as External Clock
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 9, 12 or 15 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_TIxExternalCLKSource: Trigger source.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_TIxExternalCLK1Source_TI1ED: TI1 Edge Detector
+ * @arg TIM_TIxExternalCLK1Source_TI1: Filtered Timer Input 1
+ * @arg TIM_TIxExternalCLK1Source_TI2: Filtered Timer Input 2
+ * @param TIM_ICPolarity: specifies the TIx Polarity.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ICPolarity_Rising
+ * @arg TIM_ICPolarity_Falling
+ * @param ICFilter : specifies the filter value.
+ * This parameter must be a value between 0x0 and 0xF.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_TIxExternalClockConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_TIxExternalCLKSource,
+ uint16_t TIM_ICPolarity, uint16_t ICFilter)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST6_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_TIXCLK_SOURCE(TIM_TIxExternalCLKSource));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_IC_POLARITY(TIM_ICPolarity));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_IC_FILTER(ICFilter));
+ /* Configure the Timer Input Clock Source */
+ if (TIM_TIxExternalCLKSource == TIM_TIxExternalCLK1Source_TI2)
+ {
+ TI2_Config(TIMx, TIM_ICPolarity, TIM_ICSelection_DirectTI, ICFilter);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ TI1_Config(TIMx, TIM_ICPolarity, TIM_ICSelection_DirectTI, ICFilter);
+ }
+ /* Select the Trigger source */
+ TIM_SelectInputTrigger(TIMx, TIM_TIxExternalCLKSource);
+ /* Select the External clock mode1 */
+ TIMx->SMCR |= TIM_SlaveMode_External1;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the External clock Mode1
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_ExtTRGPrescaler: The external Trigger Prescaler.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ExtTRGPSC_OFF: ETRP Prescaler OFF.
+ * @arg TIM_ExtTRGPSC_DIV2: ETRP frequency divided by 2.
+ * @arg TIM_ExtTRGPSC_DIV4: ETRP frequency divided by 4.
+ * @arg TIM_ExtTRGPSC_DIV8: ETRP frequency divided by 8.
+ * @param TIM_ExtTRGPolarity: The external Trigger Polarity.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ExtTRGPolarity_Inverted: active low or falling edge active.
+ * @arg TIM_ExtTRGPolarity_NonInverted: active high or rising edge active.
+ * @param ExtTRGFilter: External Trigger Filter.
+ * This parameter must be a value between 0x00 and 0x0F
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_ETRClockMode1Config(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_ExtTRGPrescaler, uint16_t TIM_ExtTRGPolarity,
+ uint16_t ExtTRGFilter)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpsmcr = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_EXT_PRESCALER(TIM_ExtTRGPrescaler));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_EXT_POLARITY(TIM_ExtTRGPolarity));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_EXT_FILTER(ExtTRGFilter));
+ /* Configure the ETR Clock source */
+ TIM_ETRConfig(TIMx, TIM_ExtTRGPrescaler, TIM_ExtTRGPolarity, ExtTRGFilter);
+
+ /* Get the TIMx SMCR register value */
+ tmpsmcr = TIMx->SMCR;
+ /* Reset the SMS Bits */
+ tmpsmcr &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_SMCR_SMS));
+ /* Select the External clock mode1 */
+ tmpsmcr |= TIM_SlaveMode_External1;
+ /* Select the Trigger selection : ETRF */
+ tmpsmcr &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_SMCR_TS));
+ tmpsmcr |= TIM_TS_ETRF;
+ /* Write to TIMx SMCR */
+ TIMx->SMCR = tmpsmcr;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the External clock Mode2
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_ExtTRGPrescaler: The external Trigger Prescaler.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ExtTRGPSC_OFF: ETRP Prescaler OFF.
+ * @arg TIM_ExtTRGPSC_DIV2: ETRP frequency divided by 2.
+ * @arg TIM_ExtTRGPSC_DIV4: ETRP frequency divided by 4.
+ * @arg TIM_ExtTRGPSC_DIV8: ETRP frequency divided by 8.
+ * @param TIM_ExtTRGPolarity: The external Trigger Polarity.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ExtTRGPolarity_Inverted: active low or falling edge active.
+ * @arg TIM_ExtTRGPolarity_NonInverted: active high or rising edge active.
+ * @param ExtTRGFilter: External Trigger Filter.
+ * This parameter must be a value between 0x00 and 0x0F
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_ETRClockMode2Config(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_ExtTRGPrescaler,
+ uint16_t TIM_ExtTRGPolarity, uint16_t ExtTRGFilter)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_EXT_PRESCALER(TIM_ExtTRGPrescaler));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_EXT_POLARITY(TIM_ExtTRGPolarity));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_EXT_FILTER(ExtTRGFilter));
+ /* Configure the ETR Clock source */
+ TIM_ETRConfig(TIMx, TIM_ExtTRGPrescaler, TIM_ExtTRGPolarity, ExtTRGFilter);
+ /* Enable the External clock mode2 */
+ TIMx->SMCR |= TIM_SMCR_ECE;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the TIMx External Trigger (ETR).
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_ExtTRGPrescaler: The external Trigger Prescaler.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ExtTRGPSC_OFF: ETRP Prescaler OFF.
+ * @arg TIM_ExtTRGPSC_DIV2: ETRP frequency divided by 2.
+ * @arg TIM_ExtTRGPSC_DIV4: ETRP frequency divided by 4.
+ * @arg TIM_ExtTRGPSC_DIV8: ETRP frequency divided by 8.
+ * @param TIM_ExtTRGPolarity: The external Trigger Polarity.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ExtTRGPolarity_Inverted: active low or falling edge active.
+ * @arg TIM_ExtTRGPolarity_NonInverted: active high or rising edge active.
+ * @param ExtTRGFilter: External Trigger Filter.
+ * This parameter must be a value between 0x00 and 0x0F
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_ETRConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_ExtTRGPrescaler, uint16_t TIM_ExtTRGPolarity,
+ uint16_t ExtTRGFilter)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpsmcr = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_EXT_PRESCALER(TIM_ExtTRGPrescaler));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_EXT_POLARITY(TIM_ExtTRGPolarity));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_EXT_FILTER(ExtTRGFilter));
+ tmpsmcr = TIMx->SMCR;
+ /* Reset the ETR Bits */
+ tmpsmcr &= SMCR_ETR_Mask;
+ /* Set the Prescaler, the Filter value and the Polarity */
+ tmpsmcr |= (uint16_t)(TIM_ExtTRGPrescaler | (uint16_t)(TIM_ExtTRGPolarity | (uint16_t)(ExtTRGFilter << (uint16_t)8)));
+ /* Write to TIMx SMCR */
+ TIMx->SMCR = tmpsmcr;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the TIMx Prescaler.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param Prescaler: specifies the Prescaler Register value
+ * @param TIM_PSCReloadMode: specifies the TIM Prescaler Reload mode
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_PSCReloadMode_Update: The Prescaler is loaded at the update event.
+ * @arg TIM_PSCReloadMode_Immediate: The Prescaler is loaded immediately.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_PrescalerConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t Prescaler, uint16_t TIM_PSCReloadMode)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_ALL_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_PRESCALER_RELOAD(TIM_PSCReloadMode));
+ /* Set the Prescaler value */
+ TIMx->PSC = Prescaler;
+ /* Set or reset the UG Bit */
+ TIMx->EGR = TIM_PSCReloadMode;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Specifies the TIMx Counter Mode to be used.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_CounterMode: specifies the Counter Mode to be used
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_CounterMode_Up: TIM Up Counting Mode
+ * @arg TIM_CounterMode_Down: TIM Down Counting Mode
+ * @arg TIM_CounterMode_CenterAligned1: TIM Center Aligned Mode1
+ * @arg TIM_CounterMode_CenterAligned2: TIM Center Aligned Mode2
+ * @arg TIM_CounterMode_CenterAligned3: TIM Center Aligned Mode3
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_CounterModeConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_CounterMode)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpcr1 = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_COUNTER_MODE(TIM_CounterMode));
+ tmpcr1 = TIMx->CR1;
+ /* Reset the CMS and DIR Bits */
+ tmpcr1 &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)(TIM_CR1_DIR | TIM_CR1_CMS)));
+ /* Set the Counter Mode */
+ tmpcr1 |= TIM_CounterMode;
+ /* Write to TIMx CR1 register */
+ TIMx->CR1 = tmpcr1;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Selects the Input Trigger source
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 8, 9, 12 or 15 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_InputTriggerSource: The Input Trigger source.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_TS_ITR0: Internal Trigger 0
+ * @arg TIM_TS_ITR1: Internal Trigger 1
+ * @arg TIM_TS_ITR2: Internal Trigger 2
+ * @arg TIM_TS_ITR3: Internal Trigger 3
+ * @arg TIM_TS_TI1F_ED: TI1 Edge Detector
+ * @arg TIM_TS_TI1FP1: Filtered Timer Input 1
+ * @arg TIM_TS_TI2FP2: Filtered Timer Input 2
+ * @arg TIM_TS_ETRF: External Trigger input
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_SelectInputTrigger(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_InputTriggerSource)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpsmcr = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST6_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_TRIGGER_SELECTION(TIM_InputTriggerSource));
+ /* Get the TIMx SMCR register value */
+ tmpsmcr = TIMx->SMCR;
+ /* Reset the TS Bits */
+ tmpsmcr &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_SMCR_TS));
+ /* Set the Input Trigger source */
+ tmpsmcr |= TIM_InputTriggerSource;
+ /* Write to TIMx SMCR */
+ TIMx->SMCR = tmpsmcr;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the TIMx Encoder Interface.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_EncoderMode: specifies the TIMx Encoder Mode.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_EncoderMode_TI1: Counter counts on TI1FP1 edge depending on TI2FP2 level.
+ * @arg TIM_EncoderMode_TI2: Counter counts on TI2FP2 edge depending on TI1FP1 level.
+ * @arg TIM_EncoderMode_TI12: Counter counts on both TI1FP1 and TI2FP2 edges depending
+ * on the level of the other input.
+ * @param TIM_IC1Polarity: specifies the IC1 Polarity
+ * This parmeter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ICPolarity_Falling: IC Falling edge.
+ * @arg TIM_ICPolarity_Rising: IC Rising edge.
+ * @param TIM_IC2Polarity: specifies the IC2 Polarity
+ * This parmeter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ICPolarity_Falling: IC Falling edge.
+ * @arg TIM_ICPolarity_Rising: IC Rising edge.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_EncoderInterfaceConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_EncoderMode,
+ uint16_t TIM_IC1Polarity, uint16_t TIM_IC2Polarity)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpsmcr = 0;
+ uint16_t tmpccmr1 = 0;
+ uint16_t tmpccer = 0;
+
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST5_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_ENCODER_MODE(TIM_EncoderMode));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_IC_POLARITY(TIM_IC1Polarity));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_IC_POLARITY(TIM_IC2Polarity));
+
+ /* Get the TIMx SMCR register value */
+ tmpsmcr = TIMx->SMCR;
+
+ /* Get the TIMx CCMR1 register value */
+ tmpccmr1 = TIMx->CCMR1;
+
+ /* Get the TIMx CCER register value */
+ tmpccer = TIMx->CCER;
+
+ /* Set the encoder Mode */
+ tmpsmcr &= (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_SMCR_SMS));
+ tmpsmcr |= TIM_EncoderMode;
+
+ /* Select the Capture Compare 1 and the Capture Compare 2 as input */
+ tmpccmr1 &= (uint16_t)(((uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR1_CC1S)) & (uint16_t)(~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR1_CC2S)));
+ tmpccmr1 |= TIM_CCMR1_CC1S_0 | TIM_CCMR1_CC2S_0;
+
+ /* Set the TI1 and the TI2 Polarities */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)(((uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC1P)) & ((uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC2P)));
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(TIM_IC1Polarity | (uint16_t)(TIM_IC2Polarity << (uint16_t)4));
+
+ /* Write to TIMx SMCR */
+ TIMx->SMCR = tmpsmcr;
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR1 */
+ TIMx->CCMR1 = tmpccmr1;
+ /* Write to TIMx CCER */
+ TIMx->CCER = tmpccer;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Forces the TIMx output 1 waveform to active or inactive level.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 except 6 and 7 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_ForcedAction: specifies the forced Action to be set to the output waveform.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ForcedAction_Active: Force active level on OC1REF
+ * @arg TIM_ForcedAction_InActive: Force inactive level on OC1REF.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_ForcedOC1Config(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_ForcedAction)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmr1 = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST8_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_FORCED_ACTION(TIM_ForcedAction));
+ tmpccmr1 = TIMx->CCMR1;
+ /* Reset the OC1M Bits */
+ tmpccmr1 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR1_OC1M);
+ /* Configure The Forced output Mode */
+ tmpccmr1 |= TIM_ForcedAction;
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR1 register */
+ TIMx->CCMR1 = tmpccmr1;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Forces the TIMx output 2 waveform to active or inactive level.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 8, 9, 12 or 15 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_ForcedAction: specifies the forced Action to be set to the output waveform.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ForcedAction_Active: Force active level on OC2REF
+ * @arg TIM_ForcedAction_InActive: Force inactive level on OC2REF.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_ForcedOC2Config(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_ForcedAction)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmr1 = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST6_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_FORCED_ACTION(TIM_ForcedAction));
+ tmpccmr1 = TIMx->CCMR1;
+ /* Reset the OC2M Bits */
+ tmpccmr1 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR1_OC2M);
+ /* Configure The Forced output Mode */
+ tmpccmr1 |= (uint16_t)(TIM_ForcedAction << 8);
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR1 register */
+ TIMx->CCMR1 = tmpccmr1;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Forces the TIMx output 3 waveform to active or inactive level.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_ForcedAction: specifies the forced Action to be set to the output waveform.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ForcedAction_Active: Force active level on OC3REF
+ * @arg TIM_ForcedAction_InActive: Force inactive level on OC3REF.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_ForcedOC3Config(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_ForcedAction)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmr2 = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_FORCED_ACTION(TIM_ForcedAction));
+ tmpccmr2 = TIMx->CCMR2;
+ /* Reset the OC1M Bits */
+ tmpccmr2 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR2_OC3M);
+ /* Configure The Forced output Mode */
+ tmpccmr2 |= TIM_ForcedAction;
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR2 register */
+ TIMx->CCMR2 = tmpccmr2;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Forces the TIMx output 4 waveform to active or inactive level.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_ForcedAction: specifies the forced Action to be set to the output waveform.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ForcedAction_Active: Force active level on OC4REF
+ * @arg TIM_ForcedAction_InActive: Force inactive level on OC4REF.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_ForcedOC4Config(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_ForcedAction)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmr2 = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_FORCED_ACTION(TIM_ForcedAction));
+ tmpccmr2 = TIMx->CCMR2;
+ /* Reset the OC2M Bits */
+ tmpccmr2 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR2_OC4M);
+ /* Configure The Forced output Mode */
+ tmpccmr2 |= (uint16_t)(TIM_ForcedAction << 8);
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR2 register */
+ TIMx->CCMR2 = tmpccmr2;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables TIMx peripheral Preload register on ARR.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the TIMx peripheral Preload register
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_ARRPreloadConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_ALL_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Set the ARR Preload Bit */
+ TIMx->CR1 |= TIM_CR1_ARPE;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Reset the ARR Preload Bit */
+ TIMx->CR1 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CR1_ARPE);
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Selects the TIM peripheral Commutation event.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 8, 15, 16 or 17 to select the TIMx peripheral
+ * @param NewState: new state of the Commutation event.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_SelectCOM(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST2_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Set the COM Bit */
+ TIMx->CR2 |= TIM_CR2_CCUS;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Reset the COM Bit */
+ TIMx->CR2 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CR2_CCUS);
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Selects the TIMx peripheral Capture Compare DMA source.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 8, 15, 16 or 17 to select
+ * the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the Capture Compare DMA source
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_SelectCCDMA(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST4_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Set the CCDS Bit */
+ TIMx->CR2 |= TIM_CR2_CCDS;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Reset the CCDS Bit */
+ TIMx->CR2 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CR2_CCDS);
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sets or Resets the TIM peripheral Capture Compare Preload Control bit.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 8 or 15
+ * to select the TIMx peripheral
+ * @param NewState: new state of the Capture Compare Preload Control bit
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_CCPreloadControl(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST5_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Set the CCPC Bit */
+ TIMx->CR2 |= TIM_CR2_CCPC;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Reset the CCPC Bit */
+ TIMx->CR2 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CR2_CCPC);
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the TIMx peripheral Preload register on CCR1.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 except 6 and 7 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCPreload: new state of the TIMx peripheral Preload register
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_OCPreload_Enable
+ * @arg TIM_OCPreload_Disable
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_OC1PreloadConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_OCPreload)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmr1 = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST8_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCPRELOAD_STATE(TIM_OCPreload));
+ tmpccmr1 = TIMx->CCMR1;
+ /* Reset the OC1PE Bit */
+ tmpccmr1 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR1_OC1PE);
+ /* Enable or Disable the Output Compare Preload feature */
+ tmpccmr1 |= TIM_OCPreload;
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR1 register */
+ TIMx->CCMR1 = tmpccmr1;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the TIMx peripheral Preload register on CCR2.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 8, 9, 12 or 15 to select
+ * the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCPreload: new state of the TIMx peripheral Preload register
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_OCPreload_Enable
+ * @arg TIM_OCPreload_Disable
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_OC2PreloadConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_OCPreload)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmr1 = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST6_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCPRELOAD_STATE(TIM_OCPreload));
+ tmpccmr1 = TIMx->CCMR1;
+ /* Reset the OC2PE Bit */
+ tmpccmr1 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR1_OC2PE);
+ /* Enable or Disable the Output Compare Preload feature */
+ tmpccmr1 |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCPreload << 8);
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR1 register */
+ TIMx->CCMR1 = tmpccmr1;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the TIMx peripheral Preload register on CCR3.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCPreload: new state of the TIMx peripheral Preload register
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_OCPreload_Enable
+ * @arg TIM_OCPreload_Disable
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_OC3PreloadConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_OCPreload)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmr2 = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCPRELOAD_STATE(TIM_OCPreload));
+ tmpccmr2 = TIMx->CCMR2;
+ /* Reset the OC3PE Bit */
+ tmpccmr2 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR2_OC3PE);
+ /* Enable or Disable the Output Compare Preload feature */
+ tmpccmr2 |= TIM_OCPreload;
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR2 register */
+ TIMx->CCMR2 = tmpccmr2;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the TIMx peripheral Preload register on CCR4.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCPreload: new state of the TIMx peripheral Preload register
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_OCPreload_Enable
+ * @arg TIM_OCPreload_Disable
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_OC4PreloadConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_OCPreload)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmr2 = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCPRELOAD_STATE(TIM_OCPreload));
+ tmpccmr2 = TIMx->CCMR2;
+ /* Reset the OC4PE Bit */
+ tmpccmr2 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR2_OC4PE);
+ /* Enable or Disable the Output Compare Preload feature */
+ tmpccmr2 |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCPreload << 8);
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR2 register */
+ TIMx->CCMR2 = tmpccmr2;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the TIMx Output Compare 1 Fast feature.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 except 6 and 7 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCFast: new state of the Output Compare Fast Enable Bit.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_OCFast_Enable: TIM output compare fast enable
+ * @arg TIM_OCFast_Disable: TIM output compare fast disable
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_OC1FastConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_OCFast)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmr1 = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST8_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCFAST_STATE(TIM_OCFast));
+ /* Get the TIMx CCMR1 register value */
+ tmpccmr1 = TIMx->CCMR1;
+ /* Reset the OC1FE Bit */
+ tmpccmr1 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR1_OC1FE);
+ /* Enable or Disable the Output Compare Fast Bit */
+ tmpccmr1 |= TIM_OCFast;
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR1 */
+ TIMx->CCMR1 = tmpccmr1;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the TIMx Output Compare 2 Fast feature.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 8, 9, 12 or 15 to select
+ * the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCFast: new state of the Output Compare Fast Enable Bit.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_OCFast_Enable: TIM output compare fast enable
+ * @arg TIM_OCFast_Disable: TIM output compare fast disable
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_OC2FastConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_OCFast)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmr1 = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST6_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCFAST_STATE(TIM_OCFast));
+ /* Get the TIMx CCMR1 register value */
+ tmpccmr1 = TIMx->CCMR1;
+ /* Reset the OC2FE Bit */
+ tmpccmr1 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR1_OC2FE);
+ /* Enable or Disable the Output Compare Fast Bit */
+ tmpccmr1 |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCFast << 8);
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR1 */
+ TIMx->CCMR1 = tmpccmr1;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the TIMx Output Compare 3 Fast feature.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCFast: new state of the Output Compare Fast Enable Bit.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_OCFast_Enable: TIM output compare fast enable
+ * @arg TIM_OCFast_Disable: TIM output compare fast disable
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_OC3FastConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_OCFast)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmr2 = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCFAST_STATE(TIM_OCFast));
+ /* Get the TIMx CCMR2 register value */
+ tmpccmr2 = TIMx->CCMR2;
+ /* Reset the OC3FE Bit */
+ tmpccmr2 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR2_OC3FE);
+ /* Enable or Disable the Output Compare Fast Bit */
+ tmpccmr2 |= TIM_OCFast;
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR2 */
+ TIMx->CCMR2 = tmpccmr2;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the TIMx Output Compare 4 Fast feature.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCFast: new state of the Output Compare Fast Enable Bit.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_OCFast_Enable: TIM output compare fast enable
+ * @arg TIM_OCFast_Disable: TIM output compare fast disable
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_OC4FastConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_OCFast)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmr2 = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCFAST_STATE(TIM_OCFast));
+ /* Get the TIMx CCMR2 register value */
+ tmpccmr2 = TIMx->CCMR2;
+ /* Reset the OC4FE Bit */
+ tmpccmr2 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR2_OC4FE);
+ /* Enable or Disable the Output Compare Fast Bit */
+ tmpccmr2 |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCFast << 8);
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR2 */
+ TIMx->CCMR2 = tmpccmr2;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Clears or safeguards the OCREF1 signal on an external event
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCClear: new state of the Output Compare Clear Enable Bit.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_OCClear_Enable: TIM Output clear enable
+ * @arg TIM_OCClear_Disable: TIM Output clear disable
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_ClearOC1Ref(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_OCClear)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmr1 = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCCLEAR_STATE(TIM_OCClear));
+
+ tmpccmr1 = TIMx->CCMR1;
+
+ /* Reset the OC1CE Bit */
+ tmpccmr1 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR1_OC1CE);
+ /* Enable or Disable the Output Compare Clear Bit */
+ tmpccmr1 |= TIM_OCClear;
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR1 register */
+ TIMx->CCMR1 = tmpccmr1;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Clears or safeguards the OCREF2 signal on an external event
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCClear: new state of the Output Compare Clear Enable Bit.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_OCClear_Enable: TIM Output clear enable
+ * @arg TIM_OCClear_Disable: TIM Output clear disable
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_ClearOC2Ref(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_OCClear)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmr1 = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCCLEAR_STATE(TIM_OCClear));
+ tmpccmr1 = TIMx->CCMR1;
+ /* Reset the OC2CE Bit */
+ tmpccmr1 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR1_OC2CE);
+ /* Enable or Disable the Output Compare Clear Bit */
+ tmpccmr1 |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCClear << 8);
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR1 register */
+ TIMx->CCMR1 = tmpccmr1;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Clears or safeguards the OCREF3 signal on an external event
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCClear: new state of the Output Compare Clear Enable Bit.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_OCClear_Enable: TIM Output clear enable
+ * @arg TIM_OCClear_Disable: TIM Output clear disable
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_ClearOC3Ref(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_OCClear)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmr2 = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCCLEAR_STATE(TIM_OCClear));
+ tmpccmr2 = TIMx->CCMR2;
+ /* Reset the OC3CE Bit */
+ tmpccmr2 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR2_OC3CE);
+ /* Enable or Disable the Output Compare Clear Bit */
+ tmpccmr2 |= TIM_OCClear;
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR2 register */
+ TIMx->CCMR2 = tmpccmr2;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Clears or safeguards the OCREF4 signal on an external event
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCClear: new state of the Output Compare Clear Enable Bit.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_OCClear_Enable: TIM Output clear enable
+ * @arg TIM_OCClear_Disable: TIM Output clear disable
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_ClearOC4Ref(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_OCClear)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmr2 = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCCLEAR_STATE(TIM_OCClear));
+ tmpccmr2 = TIMx->CCMR2;
+ /* Reset the OC4CE Bit */
+ tmpccmr2 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR2_OC4CE);
+ /* Enable or Disable the Output Compare Clear Bit */
+ tmpccmr2 |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCClear << 8);
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR2 register */
+ TIMx->CCMR2 = tmpccmr2;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the TIMx channel 1 polarity.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 except 6 and 7 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCPolarity: specifies the OC1 Polarity
+ * This parmeter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_OCPolarity_High: Output Compare active high
+ * @arg TIM_OCPolarity_Low: Output Compare active low
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_OC1PolarityConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_OCPolarity)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccer = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST8_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OC_POLARITY(TIM_OCPolarity));
+ tmpccer = TIMx->CCER;
+ /* Set or Reset the CC1P Bit */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC1P);
+ tmpccer |= TIM_OCPolarity;
+ /* Write to TIMx CCER register */
+ TIMx->CCER = tmpccer;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the TIMx Channel 1N polarity.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 8, 15, 16 or 17 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCNPolarity: specifies the OC1N Polarity
+ * This parmeter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_OCNPolarity_High: Output Compare active high
+ * @arg TIM_OCNPolarity_Low: Output Compare active low
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_OC1NPolarityConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_OCNPolarity)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccer = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST2_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCN_POLARITY(TIM_OCNPolarity));
+
+ tmpccer = TIMx->CCER;
+ /* Set or Reset the CC1NP Bit */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC1NP);
+ tmpccer |= TIM_OCNPolarity;
+ /* Write to TIMx CCER register */
+ TIMx->CCER = tmpccer;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the TIMx channel 2 polarity.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 8, 9, 12 or 15 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCPolarity: specifies the OC2 Polarity
+ * This parmeter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_OCPolarity_High: Output Compare active high
+ * @arg TIM_OCPolarity_Low: Output Compare active low
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_OC2PolarityConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_OCPolarity)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccer = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST6_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OC_POLARITY(TIM_OCPolarity));
+ tmpccer = TIMx->CCER;
+ /* Set or Reset the CC2P Bit */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC2P);
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCPolarity << 4);
+ /* Write to TIMx CCER register */
+ TIMx->CCER = tmpccer;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the TIMx Channel 2N polarity.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCNPolarity: specifies the OC2N Polarity
+ * This parmeter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_OCNPolarity_High: Output Compare active high
+ * @arg TIM_OCNPolarity_Low: Output Compare active low
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_OC2NPolarityConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_OCNPolarity)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccer = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST1_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCN_POLARITY(TIM_OCNPolarity));
+
+ tmpccer = TIMx->CCER;
+ /* Set or Reset the CC2NP Bit */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC2NP);
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCNPolarity << 4);
+ /* Write to TIMx CCER register */
+ TIMx->CCER = tmpccer;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the TIMx channel 3 polarity.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCPolarity: specifies the OC3 Polarity
+ * This parmeter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_OCPolarity_High: Output Compare active high
+ * @arg TIM_OCPolarity_Low: Output Compare active low
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_OC3PolarityConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_OCPolarity)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccer = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OC_POLARITY(TIM_OCPolarity));
+ tmpccer = TIMx->CCER;
+ /* Set or Reset the CC3P Bit */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC3P);
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCPolarity << 8);
+ /* Write to TIMx CCER register */
+ TIMx->CCER = tmpccer;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the TIMx Channel 3N polarity.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCNPolarity: specifies the OC3N Polarity
+ * This parmeter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_OCNPolarity_High: Output Compare active high
+ * @arg TIM_OCNPolarity_Low: Output Compare active low
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_OC3NPolarityConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_OCNPolarity)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccer = 0;
+
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST1_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCN_POLARITY(TIM_OCNPolarity));
+
+ tmpccer = TIMx->CCER;
+ /* Set or Reset the CC3NP Bit */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC3NP);
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCNPolarity << 8);
+ /* Write to TIMx CCER register */
+ TIMx->CCER = tmpccer;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the TIMx channel 4 polarity.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OCPolarity: specifies the OC4 Polarity
+ * This parmeter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_OCPolarity_High: Output Compare active high
+ * @arg TIM_OCPolarity_Low: Output Compare active low
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_OC4PolarityConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_OCPolarity)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccer = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OC_POLARITY(TIM_OCPolarity));
+ tmpccer = TIMx->CCER;
+ /* Set or Reset the CC4P Bit */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC4P);
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCPolarity << 12);
+ /* Write to TIMx CCER register */
+ TIMx->CCER = tmpccer;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the TIM Capture Compare Channel x.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 except 6 and 7 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_Channel: specifies the TIM Channel
+ * This parmeter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_Channel_1: TIM Channel 1
+ * @arg TIM_Channel_2: TIM Channel 2
+ * @arg TIM_Channel_3: TIM Channel 3
+ * @arg TIM_Channel_4: TIM Channel 4
+ * @param TIM_CCx: specifies the TIM Channel CCxE bit new state.
+ * This parameter can be: TIM_CCx_Enable or TIM_CCx_Disable.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_CCxCmd(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_Channel, uint16_t TIM_CCx)
+{
+ uint16_t tmp = 0;
+
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST8_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_CHANNEL(TIM_Channel));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_CCX(TIM_CCx));
+
+ tmp = CCER_CCE_Set << TIM_Channel;
+
+ /* Reset the CCxE Bit */
+ TIMx->CCER &= (uint16_t)~ tmp;
+
+ /* Set or reset the CCxE Bit */
+ TIMx->CCER |= (uint16_t)(TIM_CCx << TIM_Channel);
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the TIM Capture Compare Channel xN.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 8, 15, 16 or 17 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_Channel: specifies the TIM Channel
+ * This parmeter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_Channel_1: TIM Channel 1
+ * @arg TIM_Channel_2: TIM Channel 2
+ * @arg TIM_Channel_3: TIM Channel 3
+ * @param TIM_CCxN: specifies the TIM Channel CCxNE bit new state.
+ * This parameter can be: TIM_CCxN_Enable or TIM_CCxN_Disable.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_CCxNCmd(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_Channel, uint16_t TIM_CCxN)
+{
+ uint16_t tmp = 0;
+
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST2_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_COMPLEMENTARY_CHANNEL(TIM_Channel));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_CCXN(TIM_CCxN));
+
+ tmp = CCER_CCNE_Set << TIM_Channel;
+
+ /* Reset the CCxNE Bit */
+ TIMx->CCER &= (uint16_t) ~tmp;
+
+ /* Set or reset the CCxNE Bit */
+ TIMx->CCER |= (uint16_t)(TIM_CCxN << TIM_Channel);
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Selects the TIM Ouput Compare Mode.
+ * @note This function disables the selected channel before changing the Ouput
+ * Compare Mode.
+ * User has to enable this channel using TIM_CCxCmd and TIM_CCxNCmd functions.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 except 6 and 7 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_Channel: specifies the TIM Channel
+ * This parmeter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_Channel_1: TIM Channel 1
+ * @arg TIM_Channel_2: TIM Channel 2
+ * @arg TIM_Channel_3: TIM Channel 3
+ * @arg TIM_Channel_4: TIM Channel 4
+ * @param TIM_OCMode: specifies the TIM Output Compare Mode.
+ * This paramter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_OCMode_Timing
+ * @arg TIM_OCMode_Active
+ * @arg TIM_OCMode_Toggle
+ * @arg TIM_OCMode_PWM1
+ * @arg TIM_OCMode_PWM2
+ * @arg TIM_ForcedAction_Active
+ * @arg TIM_ForcedAction_InActive
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_SelectOCxM(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_Channel, uint16_t TIM_OCMode)
+{
+ uint32_t tmp = 0;
+ uint16_t tmp1 = 0;
+
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST8_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_CHANNEL(TIM_Channel));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OCM(TIM_OCMode));
+
+ tmp = (uint32_t) TIMx;
+ tmp += CCMR_Offset;
+
+ tmp1 = CCER_CCE_Set << (uint16_t)TIM_Channel;
+
+ /* Disable the Channel: Reset the CCxE Bit */
+ TIMx->CCER &= (uint16_t) ~tmp1;
+
+ if((TIM_Channel == TIM_Channel_1) ||(TIM_Channel == TIM_Channel_3))
+ {
+ tmp += (TIM_Channel>>1);
+
+ /* Reset the OCxM bits in the CCMRx register */
+ *(__IO uint32_t *) tmp &= (uint32_t)~((uint32_t)TIM_CCMR1_OC1M);
+
+ /* Configure the OCxM bits in the CCMRx register */
+ *(__IO uint32_t *) tmp |= TIM_OCMode;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ tmp += (uint16_t)(TIM_Channel - (uint16_t)4)>> (uint16_t)1;
+
+ /* Reset the OCxM bits in the CCMRx register */
+ *(__IO uint32_t *) tmp &= (uint32_t)~((uint32_t)TIM_CCMR1_OC2M);
+
+ /* Configure the OCxM bits in the CCMRx register */
+ *(__IO uint32_t *) tmp |= (uint16_t)(TIM_OCMode << 8);
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or Disables the TIMx Update event.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the TIMx UDIS bit
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_UpdateDisableConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_ALL_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Set the Update Disable Bit */
+ TIMx->CR1 |= TIM_CR1_UDIS;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Reset the Update Disable Bit */
+ TIMx->CR1 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CR1_UDIS);
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the TIMx Update Request Interrupt source.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_UpdateSource: specifies the Update source.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_UpdateSource_Regular: Source of update is the counter overflow/underflow
+ or the setting of UG bit, or an update generation
+ through the slave mode controller.
+ * @arg TIM_UpdateSource_Global: Source of update is counter overflow/underflow.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_UpdateRequestConfig(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_UpdateSource)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_ALL_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_UPDATE_SOURCE(TIM_UpdateSource));
+ if (TIM_UpdateSource != TIM_UpdateSource_Global)
+ {
+ /* Set the URS Bit */
+ TIMx->CR1 |= TIM_CR1_URS;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Reset the URS Bit */
+ TIMx->CR1 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CR1_URS);
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the TIMx’s Hall sensor interface.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the TIMx Hall sensor interface.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_SelectHallSensor(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST6_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Set the TI1S Bit */
+ TIMx->CR2 |= TIM_CR2_TI1S;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Reset the TI1S Bit */
+ TIMx->CR2 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CR2_TI1S);
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Selects the TIMx’s One Pulse Mode.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_OPMode: specifies the OPM Mode to be used.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_OPMode_Single
+ * @arg TIM_OPMode_Repetitive
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_SelectOnePulseMode(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_OPMode)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_ALL_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_OPM_MODE(TIM_OPMode));
+ /* Reset the OPM Bit */
+ TIMx->CR1 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CR1_OPM);
+ /* Configure the OPM Mode */
+ TIMx->CR1 |= TIM_OPMode;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Selects the TIMx Trigger Output Mode.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 12 or 15 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_TRGOSource: specifies the Trigger Output source.
+ * This paramter can be one of the following values:
+ *
+ * - For all TIMx
+ * @arg TIM_TRGOSource_Reset: The UG bit in the TIM_EGR register is used as the trigger output (TRGO).
+ * @arg TIM_TRGOSource_Enable: The Counter Enable CEN is used as the trigger output (TRGO).
+ * @arg TIM_TRGOSource_Update: The update event is selected as the trigger output (TRGO).
+ *
+ * - For all TIMx except TIM6 and TIM7
+ * @arg TIM_TRGOSource_OC1: The trigger output sends a positive pulse when the CC1IF flag
+ * is to be set, as soon as a capture or compare match occurs (TRGO).
+ * @arg TIM_TRGOSource_OC1Ref: OC1REF signal is used as the trigger output (TRGO).
+ * @arg TIM_TRGOSource_OC2Ref: OC2REF signal is used as the trigger output (TRGO).
+ * @arg TIM_TRGOSource_OC3Ref: OC3REF signal is used as the trigger output (TRGO).
+ * @arg TIM_TRGOSource_OC4Ref: OC4REF signal is used as the trigger output (TRGO).
+ *
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_SelectOutputTrigger(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_TRGOSource)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST7_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_TRGO_SOURCE(TIM_TRGOSource));
+ /* Reset the MMS Bits */
+ TIMx->CR2 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CR2_MMS);
+ /* Select the TRGO source */
+ TIMx->CR2 |= TIM_TRGOSource;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Selects the TIMx Slave Mode.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 8, 9, 12 or 15 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_SlaveMode: specifies the Timer Slave Mode.
+ * This paramter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_SlaveMode_Reset: Rising edge of the selected trigger signal (TRGI) re-initializes
+ * the counter and triggers an update of the registers.
+ * @arg TIM_SlaveMode_Gated: The counter clock is enabled when the trigger signal (TRGI) is high.
+ * @arg TIM_SlaveMode_Trigger: The counter starts at a rising edge of the trigger TRGI.
+ * @arg TIM_SlaveMode_External1: Rising edges of the selected trigger (TRGI) clock the counter.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_SelectSlaveMode(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_SlaveMode)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST6_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_SLAVE_MODE(TIM_SlaveMode));
+ /* Reset the SMS Bits */
+ TIMx->SMCR &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_SMCR_SMS);
+ /* Select the Slave Mode */
+ TIMx->SMCR |= TIM_SlaveMode;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sets or Resets the TIMx Master/Slave Mode.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 8, 9, 12 or 15 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_MasterSlaveMode: specifies the Timer Master Slave Mode.
+ * This paramter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_MasterSlaveMode_Enable: synchronization between the current timer
+ * and its slaves (through TRGO).
+ * @arg TIM_MasterSlaveMode_Disable: No action
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_SelectMasterSlaveMode(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_MasterSlaveMode)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST6_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_MSM_STATE(TIM_MasterSlaveMode));
+ /* Reset the MSM Bit */
+ TIMx->SMCR &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_SMCR_MSM);
+
+ /* Set or Reset the MSM Bit */
+ TIMx->SMCR |= TIM_MasterSlaveMode;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sets the TIMx Counter Register value
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param Counter: specifies the Counter register new value.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_SetCounter(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t Counter)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_ALL_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ /* Set the Counter Register value */
+ TIMx->CNT = Counter;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sets the TIMx Autoreload Register value
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param Autoreload: specifies the Autoreload register new value.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_SetAutoreload(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t Autoreload)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_ALL_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ /* Set the Autoreload Register value */
+ TIMx->ARR = Autoreload;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sets the TIMx Capture Compare1 Register value
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 except 6 and 7 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param Compare1: specifies the Capture Compare1 register new value.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_SetCompare1(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t Compare1)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST8_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ /* Set the Capture Compare1 Register value */
+ TIMx->CCR1 = Compare1;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sets the TIMx Capture Compare2 Register value
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 8, 9, 12 or 15 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param Compare2: specifies the Capture Compare2 register new value.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_SetCompare2(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t Compare2)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST6_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ /* Set the Capture Compare2 Register value */
+ TIMx->CCR2 = Compare2;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sets the TIMx Capture Compare3 Register value
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param Compare3: specifies the Capture Compare3 register new value.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_SetCompare3(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t Compare3)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ /* Set the Capture Compare3 Register value */
+ TIMx->CCR3 = Compare3;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sets the TIMx Capture Compare4 Register value
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param Compare4: specifies the Capture Compare4 register new value.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_SetCompare4(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t Compare4)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ /* Set the Capture Compare4 Register value */
+ TIMx->CCR4 = Compare4;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sets the TIMx Input Capture 1 prescaler.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 except 6 and 7 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_ICPSC: specifies the Input Capture1 prescaler new value.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ICPSC_DIV1: no prescaler
+ * @arg TIM_ICPSC_DIV2: capture is done once every 2 events
+ * @arg TIM_ICPSC_DIV4: capture is done once every 4 events
+ * @arg TIM_ICPSC_DIV8: capture is done once every 8 events
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_SetIC1Prescaler(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_ICPSC)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST8_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_IC_PRESCALER(TIM_ICPSC));
+ /* Reset the IC1PSC Bits */
+ TIMx->CCMR1 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR1_IC1PSC);
+ /* Set the IC1PSC value */
+ TIMx->CCMR1 |= TIM_ICPSC;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sets the TIMx Input Capture 2 prescaler.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 8, 9, 12 or 15 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_ICPSC: specifies the Input Capture2 prescaler new value.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ICPSC_DIV1: no prescaler
+ * @arg TIM_ICPSC_DIV2: capture is done once every 2 events
+ * @arg TIM_ICPSC_DIV4: capture is done once every 4 events
+ * @arg TIM_ICPSC_DIV8: capture is done once every 8 events
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_SetIC2Prescaler(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_ICPSC)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST6_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_IC_PRESCALER(TIM_ICPSC));
+ /* Reset the IC2PSC Bits */
+ TIMx->CCMR1 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR1_IC2PSC);
+ /* Set the IC2PSC value */
+ TIMx->CCMR1 |= (uint16_t)(TIM_ICPSC << 8);
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sets the TIMx Input Capture 3 prescaler.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_ICPSC: specifies the Input Capture3 prescaler new value.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ICPSC_DIV1: no prescaler
+ * @arg TIM_ICPSC_DIV2: capture is done once every 2 events
+ * @arg TIM_ICPSC_DIV4: capture is done once every 4 events
+ * @arg TIM_ICPSC_DIV8: capture is done once every 8 events
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_SetIC3Prescaler(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_ICPSC)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_IC_PRESCALER(TIM_ICPSC));
+ /* Reset the IC3PSC Bits */
+ TIMx->CCMR2 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR2_IC3PSC);
+ /* Set the IC3PSC value */
+ TIMx->CCMR2 |= TIM_ICPSC;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sets the TIMx Input Capture 4 prescaler.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_ICPSC: specifies the Input Capture4 prescaler new value.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ICPSC_DIV1: no prescaler
+ * @arg TIM_ICPSC_DIV2: capture is done once every 2 events
+ * @arg TIM_ICPSC_DIV4: capture is done once every 4 events
+ * @arg TIM_ICPSC_DIV8: capture is done once every 8 events
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_SetIC4Prescaler(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_ICPSC)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_IC_PRESCALER(TIM_ICPSC));
+ /* Reset the IC4PSC Bits */
+ TIMx->CCMR2 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR2_IC4PSC);
+ /* Set the IC4PSC value */
+ TIMx->CCMR2 |= (uint16_t)(TIM_ICPSC << 8);
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sets the TIMx Clock Division value.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 except 6 and 7 to select
+ * the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_CKD: specifies the clock division value.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following value:
+ * @arg TIM_CKD_DIV1: TDTS = Tck_tim
+ * @arg TIM_CKD_DIV2: TDTS = 2*Tck_tim
+ * @arg TIM_CKD_DIV4: TDTS = 4*Tck_tim
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_SetClockDivision(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_CKD)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST8_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_CKD_DIV(TIM_CKD));
+ /* Reset the CKD Bits */
+ TIMx->CR1 &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CR1_CKD);
+ /* Set the CKD value */
+ TIMx->CR1 |= TIM_CKD;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Gets the TIMx Input Capture 1 value.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 except 6 and 7 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @retval Capture Compare 1 Register value.
+ */
+uint16_t TIM_GetCapture1(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST8_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ /* Get the Capture 1 Register value */
+ return TIMx->CCR1;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Gets the TIMx Input Capture 2 value.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 8, 9, 12 or 15 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @retval Capture Compare 2 Register value.
+ */
+uint16_t TIM_GetCapture2(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST6_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ /* Get the Capture 2 Register value */
+ return TIMx->CCR2;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Gets the TIMx Input Capture 3 value.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @retval Capture Compare 3 Register value.
+ */
+uint16_t TIM_GetCapture3(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ /* Get the Capture 3 Register value */
+ return TIMx->CCR3;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Gets the TIMx Input Capture 4 value.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @retval Capture Compare 4 Register value.
+ */
+uint16_t TIM_GetCapture4(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_LIST3_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ /* Get the Capture 4 Register value */
+ return TIMx->CCR4;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Gets the TIMx Counter value.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @retval Counter Register value.
+ */
+uint16_t TIM_GetCounter(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_ALL_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ /* Get the Counter Register value */
+ return TIMx->CNT;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Gets the TIMx Prescaler value.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @retval Prescaler Register value.
+ */
+uint16_t TIM_GetPrescaler(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_ALL_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ /* Get the Prescaler Register value */
+ return TIMx->PSC;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Checks whether the specified TIM flag is set or not.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_FLAG: specifies the flag to check.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_Update: TIM update Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_CC1: TIM Capture Compare 1 Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_CC2: TIM Capture Compare 2 Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_CC3: TIM Capture Compare 3 Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_CC4: TIM Capture Compare 4 Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_COM: TIM Commutation Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_Trigger: TIM Trigger Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_Break: TIM Break Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_CC1OF: TIM Capture Compare 1 overcapture Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_CC2OF: TIM Capture Compare 2 overcapture Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_CC3OF: TIM Capture Compare 3 overcapture Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_CC4OF: TIM Capture Compare 4 overcapture Flag
+ * @note
+ * - TIM6 and TIM7 can have only one update flag.
+ * - TIM9, TIM12 and TIM15 can have only TIM_FLAG_Update, TIM_FLAG_CC1,
+ * TIM_FLAG_CC2 or TIM_FLAG_Trigger.
+ * - TIM10, TIM11, TIM13, TIM14, TIM16 and TIM17 can have TIM_FLAG_Update or TIM_FLAG_CC1.
+ * - TIM_FLAG_Break is used only with TIM1, TIM8 and TIM15.
+ * - TIM_FLAG_COM is used only with TIM1, TIM8, TIM15, TIM16 and TIM17.
+ * @retval The new state of TIM_FLAG (SET or RESET).
+ */
+FlagStatus TIM_GetFlagStatus(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_FLAG)
+{
+ ITStatus bitstatus = RESET;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_ALL_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_GET_FLAG(TIM_FLAG));
+
+ if ((TIMx->SR & TIM_FLAG) != (uint16_t)RESET)
+ {
+ bitstatus = SET;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ bitstatus = RESET;
+ }
+ return bitstatus;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Clears the TIMx's pending flags.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_FLAG: specifies the flag bit to clear.
+ * This parameter can be any combination of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_Update: TIM update Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_CC1: TIM Capture Compare 1 Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_CC2: TIM Capture Compare 2 Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_CC3: TIM Capture Compare 3 Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_CC4: TIM Capture Compare 4 Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_COM: TIM Commutation Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_Trigger: TIM Trigger Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_Break: TIM Break Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_CC1OF: TIM Capture Compare 1 overcapture Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_CC2OF: TIM Capture Compare 2 overcapture Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_CC3OF: TIM Capture Compare 3 overcapture Flag
+ * @arg TIM_FLAG_CC4OF: TIM Capture Compare 4 overcapture Flag
+ * @note
+ * - TIM6 and TIM7 can have only one update flag.
+ * - TIM9, TIM12 and TIM15 can have only TIM_FLAG_Update, TIM_FLAG_CC1,
+ * TIM_FLAG_CC2 or TIM_FLAG_Trigger.
+ * - TIM10, TIM11, TIM13, TIM14, TIM16 and TIM17 can have TIM_FLAG_Update or TIM_FLAG_CC1.
+ * - TIM_FLAG_Break is used only with TIM1, TIM8 and TIM15.
+ * - TIM_FLAG_COM is used only with TIM1, TIM8, TIM15, TIM16 and TIM17.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_ClearFlag(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_FLAG)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_ALL_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_CLEAR_FLAG(TIM_FLAG));
+
+ /* Clear the flags */
+ TIMx->SR = (uint16_t)~TIM_FLAG;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Checks whether the TIM interrupt has occurred or not.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_IT: specifies the TIM interrupt source to check.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_IT_Update: TIM update Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_IT_CC1: TIM Capture Compare 1 Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_IT_CC2: TIM Capture Compare 2 Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_IT_CC3: TIM Capture Compare 3 Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_IT_CC4: TIM Capture Compare 4 Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_IT_COM: TIM Commutation Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_IT_Trigger: TIM Trigger Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_IT_Break: TIM Break Interrupt source
+ * @note
+ * - TIM6 and TIM7 can generate only an update interrupt.
+ * - TIM9, TIM12 and TIM15 can have only TIM_IT_Update, TIM_IT_CC1,
+ * TIM_IT_CC2 or TIM_IT_Trigger.
+ * - TIM10, TIM11, TIM13, TIM14, TIM16 and TIM17 can have TIM_IT_Update or TIM_IT_CC1.
+ * - TIM_IT_Break is used only with TIM1, TIM8 and TIM15.
+ * - TIM_IT_COM is used only with TIM1, TIM8, TIM15, TIM16 and TIM17.
+ * @retval The new state of the TIM_IT(SET or RESET).
+ */
+ITStatus TIM_GetITStatus(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_IT)
+{
+ ITStatus bitstatus = RESET;
+ uint16_t itstatus = 0x0, itenable = 0x0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_ALL_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_GET_IT(TIM_IT));
+
+ itstatus = TIMx->SR & TIM_IT;
+
+ itenable = TIMx->DIER & TIM_IT;
+ if ((itstatus != (uint16_t)RESET) && (itenable != (uint16_t)RESET))
+ {
+ bitstatus = SET;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ bitstatus = RESET;
+ }
+ return bitstatus;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Clears the TIMx's interrupt pending bits.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_IT: specifies the pending bit to clear.
+ * This parameter can be any combination of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_IT_Update: TIM1 update Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_IT_CC1: TIM Capture Compare 1 Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_IT_CC2: TIM Capture Compare 2 Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_IT_CC3: TIM Capture Compare 3 Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_IT_CC4: TIM Capture Compare 4 Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_IT_COM: TIM Commutation Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_IT_Trigger: TIM Trigger Interrupt source
+ * @arg TIM_IT_Break: TIM Break Interrupt source
+ * @note
+ * - TIM6 and TIM7 can generate only an update interrupt.
+ * - TIM9, TIM12 and TIM15 can have only TIM_IT_Update, TIM_IT_CC1,
+ * TIM_IT_CC2 or TIM_IT_Trigger.
+ * - TIM10, TIM11, TIM13, TIM14, TIM16 and TIM17 can have TIM_IT_Update or TIM_IT_CC1.
+ * - TIM_IT_Break is used only with TIM1, TIM8 and TIM15.
+ * - TIM_IT_COM is used only with TIM1, TIM8, TIM15, TIM16 and TIM17.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void TIM_ClearITPendingBit(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_IT)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_ALL_PERIPH(TIMx));
+ assert_param(IS_TIM_IT(TIM_IT));
+ /* Clear the IT pending Bit */
+ TIMx->SR = (uint16_t)~TIM_IT;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configure the TI1 as Input.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1 to 17 except 6 and 7 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_ICPolarity : The Input Polarity.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ICPolarity_Rising
+ * @arg TIM_ICPolarity_Falling
+ * @param TIM_ICSelection: specifies the input to be used.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ICSelection_DirectTI: TIM Input 1 is selected to be connected to IC1.
+ * @arg TIM_ICSelection_IndirectTI: TIM Input 1 is selected to be connected to IC2.
+ * @arg TIM_ICSelection_TRC: TIM Input 1 is selected to be connected to TRC.
+ * @param TIM_ICFilter: Specifies the Input Capture Filter.
+ * This parameter must be a value between 0x00 and 0x0F.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+static void TI1_Config(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_ICPolarity, uint16_t TIM_ICSelection,
+ uint16_t TIM_ICFilter)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmr1 = 0, tmpccer = 0;
+ /* Disable the Channel 1: Reset the CC1E Bit */
+ TIMx->CCER &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC1E);
+ tmpccmr1 = TIMx->CCMR1;
+ tmpccer = TIMx->CCER;
+ /* Select the Input and set the filter */
+ tmpccmr1 &= (uint16_t)(((uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR1_CC1S)) & ((uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR1_IC1F)));
+ tmpccmr1 |= (uint16_t)(TIM_ICSelection | (uint16_t)(TIM_ICFilter << (uint16_t)4));
+
+ if((TIMx == TIM1) || (TIMx == TIM8) || (TIMx == TIM2) || (TIMx == TIM3) ||
+ (TIMx == TIM4) ||(TIMx == TIM5))
+ {
+ /* Select the Polarity and set the CC1E Bit */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)(TIM_CCER_CC1P));
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(TIM_ICPolarity | (uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC1E);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Select the Polarity and set the CC1E Bit */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)(TIM_CCER_CC1P | TIM_CCER_CC1NP));
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(TIM_ICPolarity | (uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC1E);
+ }
+
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR1 and CCER registers */
+ TIMx->CCMR1 = tmpccmr1;
+ TIMx->CCER = tmpccer;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configure the TI2 as Input.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 8, 9, 12 or 15 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_ICPolarity : The Input Polarity.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ICPolarity_Rising
+ * @arg TIM_ICPolarity_Falling
+ * @param TIM_ICSelection: specifies the input to be used.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ICSelection_DirectTI: TIM Input 2 is selected to be connected to IC2.
+ * @arg TIM_ICSelection_IndirectTI: TIM Input 2 is selected to be connected to IC1.
+ * @arg TIM_ICSelection_TRC: TIM Input 2 is selected to be connected to TRC.
+ * @param TIM_ICFilter: Specifies the Input Capture Filter.
+ * This parameter must be a value between 0x00 and 0x0F.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+static void TI2_Config(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_ICPolarity, uint16_t TIM_ICSelection,
+ uint16_t TIM_ICFilter)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmr1 = 0, tmpccer = 0, tmp = 0;
+ /* Disable the Channel 2: Reset the CC2E Bit */
+ TIMx->CCER &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC2E);
+ tmpccmr1 = TIMx->CCMR1;
+ tmpccer = TIMx->CCER;
+ tmp = (uint16_t)(TIM_ICPolarity << 4);
+ /* Select the Input and set the filter */
+ tmpccmr1 &= (uint16_t)(((uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR1_CC2S)) & ((uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR1_IC2F)));
+ tmpccmr1 |= (uint16_t)(TIM_ICFilter << 12);
+ tmpccmr1 |= (uint16_t)(TIM_ICSelection << 8);
+
+ if((TIMx == TIM1) || (TIMx == TIM8) || (TIMx == TIM2) || (TIMx == TIM3) ||
+ (TIMx == TIM4) ||(TIMx == TIM5))
+ {
+ /* Select the Polarity and set the CC2E Bit */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)(TIM_CCER_CC2P));
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(tmp | (uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC2E);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Select the Polarity and set the CC2E Bit */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)(TIM_CCER_CC2P | TIM_CCER_CC2NP));
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(TIM_ICPolarity | (uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC2E);
+ }
+
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR1 and CCER registers */
+ TIMx->CCMR1 = tmpccmr1 ;
+ TIMx->CCER = tmpccer;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configure the TI3 as Input.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_ICPolarity : The Input Polarity.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ICPolarity_Rising
+ * @arg TIM_ICPolarity_Falling
+ * @param TIM_ICSelection: specifies the input to be used.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ICSelection_DirectTI: TIM Input 3 is selected to be connected to IC3.
+ * @arg TIM_ICSelection_IndirectTI: TIM Input 3 is selected to be connected to IC4.
+ * @arg TIM_ICSelection_TRC: TIM Input 3 is selected to be connected to TRC.
+ * @param TIM_ICFilter: Specifies the Input Capture Filter.
+ * This parameter must be a value between 0x00 and 0x0F.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+static void TI3_Config(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_ICPolarity, uint16_t TIM_ICSelection,
+ uint16_t TIM_ICFilter)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmr2 = 0, tmpccer = 0, tmp = 0;
+ /* Disable the Channel 3: Reset the CC3E Bit */
+ TIMx->CCER &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC3E);
+ tmpccmr2 = TIMx->CCMR2;
+ tmpccer = TIMx->CCER;
+ tmp = (uint16_t)(TIM_ICPolarity << 8);
+ /* Select the Input and set the filter */
+ tmpccmr2 &= (uint16_t)(((uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR2_CC3S)) & ((uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR2_IC3F)));
+ tmpccmr2 |= (uint16_t)(TIM_ICSelection | (uint16_t)(TIM_ICFilter << (uint16_t)4));
+
+ if((TIMx == TIM1) || (TIMx == TIM8) || (TIMx == TIM2) || (TIMx == TIM3) ||
+ (TIMx == TIM4) ||(TIMx == TIM5))
+ {
+ /* Select the Polarity and set the CC3E Bit */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)(TIM_CCER_CC3P));
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(tmp | (uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC3E);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Select the Polarity and set the CC3E Bit */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)(TIM_CCER_CC3P | TIM_CCER_CC3NP));
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(TIM_ICPolarity | (uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC3E);
+ }
+
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR2 and CCER registers */
+ TIMx->CCMR2 = tmpccmr2;
+ TIMx->CCER = tmpccer;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configure the TI4 as Input.
+ * @param TIMx: where x can be 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 8 to select the TIM peripheral.
+ * @param TIM_ICPolarity : The Input Polarity.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ICPolarity_Rising
+ * @arg TIM_ICPolarity_Falling
+ * @param TIM_ICSelection: specifies the input to be used.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg TIM_ICSelection_DirectTI: TIM Input 4 is selected to be connected to IC4.
+ * @arg TIM_ICSelection_IndirectTI: TIM Input 4 is selected to be connected to IC3.
+ * @arg TIM_ICSelection_TRC: TIM Input 4 is selected to be connected to TRC.
+ * @param TIM_ICFilter: Specifies the Input Capture Filter.
+ * This parameter must be a value between 0x00 and 0x0F.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+static void TI4_Config(TIM_TypeDef* TIMx, uint16_t TIM_ICPolarity, uint16_t TIM_ICSelection,
+ uint16_t TIM_ICFilter)
+{
+ uint16_t tmpccmr2 = 0, tmpccer = 0, tmp = 0;
+
+ /* Disable the Channel 4: Reset the CC4E Bit */
+ TIMx->CCER &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC4E);
+ tmpccmr2 = TIMx->CCMR2;
+ tmpccer = TIMx->CCER;
+ tmp = (uint16_t)(TIM_ICPolarity << 12);
+ /* Select the Input and set the filter */
+ tmpccmr2 &= (uint16_t)((uint16_t)(~(uint16_t)TIM_CCMR2_CC4S) & ((uint16_t)~((uint16_t)TIM_CCMR2_IC4F)));
+ tmpccmr2 |= (uint16_t)(TIM_ICSelection << 8);
+ tmpccmr2 |= (uint16_t)(TIM_ICFilter << 12);
+
+ if((TIMx == TIM1) || (TIMx == TIM8) || (TIMx == TIM2) || (TIMx == TIM3) ||
+ (TIMx == TIM4) ||(TIMx == TIM5))
+ {
+ /* Select the Polarity and set the CC4E Bit */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)(TIM_CCER_CC4P));
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(tmp | (uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC4E);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Select the Polarity and set the CC4E Bit */
+ tmpccer &= (uint16_t)~((uint16_t)(TIM_CCER_CC3P | TIM_CCER_CC4NP));
+ tmpccer |= (uint16_t)(TIM_ICPolarity | (uint16_t)TIM_CCER_CC4E);
+ }
+ /* Write to TIMx CCMR2 and CCER registers */
+ TIMx->CCMR2 = tmpccmr2;
+ TIMx->CCER = tmpccer;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/******************* (C) COPYRIGHT 2010 STMicroelectronics *****END OF FILE****/
diff --git a/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Libraries/STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver/src/stm32f10x_usart.c b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Libraries/STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver/src/stm32f10x_usart.c
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..eb84d977f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Libraries/STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver/src/stm32f10x_usart.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1055 @@
+/**
+ ******************************************************************************
+ * @file stm32f10x_usart.c
+ * @author MCD Application Team
+ * @version V3.4.0
+ * @date 10/15/2010
+ * @brief This file provides all the USART firmware functions.
+ ******************************************************************************
+ * @copy
+ *
+ * THE PRESENT FIRMWARE WHICH IS FOR GUIDANCE ONLY AIMS AT PROVIDING CUSTOMERS
+ * WITH CODING INFORMATION REGARDING THEIR PRODUCTS IN ORDER FOR THEM TO SAVE
+ * TIME. AS A RESULT, STMICROELECTRONICS SHALL NOT BE HELD LIABLE FOR ANY
+ * DIRECT, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES WITH RESPECT TO ANY CLAIMS ARISING
+ * FROM THE CONTENT OF SUCH FIRMWARE AND/OR THE USE MADE BY CUSTOMERS OF THE
+ * CODING INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN IN CONNECTION WITH THEIR PRODUCTS.
+ *
+ *
+ */
+
+/* Includes ------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+#include "stm32f10x_usart.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_rcc.h"
+
+/** @addtogroup STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup USART
+ * @brief USART driver modules
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup USART_Private_TypesDefinitions
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup USART_Private_Defines
+ * @{
+ */
+
+#define CR1_UE_Set ((uint16_t)0x2000) /*!< USART Enable Mask */
+#define CR1_UE_Reset ((uint16_t)0xDFFF) /*!< USART Disable Mask */
+
+#define CR1_WAKE_Mask ((uint16_t)0xF7FF) /*!< USART WakeUp Method Mask */
+
+#define CR1_RWU_Set ((uint16_t)0x0002) /*!< USART mute mode Enable Mask */
+#define CR1_RWU_Reset ((uint16_t)0xFFFD) /*!< USART mute mode Enable Mask */
+#define CR1_SBK_Set ((uint16_t)0x0001) /*!< USART Break Character send Mask */
+#define CR1_CLEAR_Mask ((uint16_t)0xE9F3) /*!< USART CR1 Mask */
+#define CR2_Address_Mask ((uint16_t)0xFFF0) /*!< USART address Mask */
+
+#define CR2_LINEN_Set ((uint16_t)0x4000) /*!< USART LIN Enable Mask */
+#define CR2_LINEN_Reset ((uint16_t)0xBFFF) /*!< USART LIN Disable Mask */
+
+#define CR2_LBDL_Mask ((uint16_t)0xFFDF) /*!< USART LIN Break detection Mask */
+#define CR2_STOP_CLEAR_Mask ((uint16_t)0xCFFF) /*!< USART CR2 STOP Bits Mask */
+#define CR2_CLOCK_CLEAR_Mask ((uint16_t)0xF0FF) /*!< USART CR2 Clock Mask */
+
+#define CR3_SCEN_Set ((uint16_t)0x0020) /*!< USART SC Enable Mask */
+#define CR3_SCEN_Reset ((uint16_t)0xFFDF) /*!< USART SC Disable Mask */
+
+#define CR3_NACK_Set ((uint16_t)0x0010) /*!< USART SC NACK Enable Mask */
+#define CR3_NACK_Reset ((uint16_t)0xFFEF) /*!< USART SC NACK Disable Mask */
+
+#define CR3_HDSEL_Set ((uint16_t)0x0008) /*!< USART Half-Duplex Enable Mask */
+#define CR3_HDSEL_Reset ((uint16_t)0xFFF7) /*!< USART Half-Duplex Disable Mask */
+
+#define CR3_IRLP_Mask ((uint16_t)0xFFFB) /*!< USART IrDA LowPower mode Mask */
+#define CR3_CLEAR_Mask ((uint16_t)0xFCFF) /*!< USART CR3 Mask */
+
+#define CR3_IREN_Set ((uint16_t)0x0002) /*!< USART IrDA Enable Mask */
+#define CR3_IREN_Reset ((uint16_t)0xFFFD) /*!< USART IrDA Disable Mask */
+#define GTPR_LSB_Mask ((uint16_t)0x00FF) /*!< Guard Time Register LSB Mask */
+#define GTPR_MSB_Mask ((uint16_t)0xFF00) /*!< Guard Time Register MSB Mask */
+#define IT_Mask ((uint16_t)0x001F) /*!< USART Interrupt Mask */
+
+/* USART OverSampling-8 Mask */
+#define CR1_OVER8_Set ((u16)0x8000) /* USART OVER8 mode Enable Mask */
+#define CR1_OVER8_Reset ((u16)0x7FFF) /* USART OVER8 mode Disable Mask */
+
+/* USART One Bit Sampling Mask */
+#define CR3_ONEBITE_Set ((u16)0x0800) /* USART ONEBITE mode Enable Mask */
+#define CR3_ONEBITE_Reset ((u16)0xF7FF) /* USART ONEBITE mode Disable Mask */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup USART_Private_Macros
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup USART_Private_Variables
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup USART_Private_FunctionPrototypes
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup USART_Private_Functions
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @brief Deinitializes the USARTx peripheral registers to their default reset values.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values: USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_DeInit(USART_TypeDef* USARTx)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+
+ if (USARTx == USART1)
+ {
+ RCC_APB2PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB2Periph_USART1, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB2PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB2Periph_USART1, DISABLE);
+ }
+ else if (USARTx == USART2)
+ {
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_USART2, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_USART2, DISABLE);
+ }
+ else if (USARTx == USART3)
+ {
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_USART3, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_USART3, DISABLE);
+ }
+ else if (USARTx == UART4)
+ {
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_UART4, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_UART4, DISABLE);
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ if (USARTx == UART5)
+ {
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_UART5, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_UART5, DISABLE);
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Initializes the USARTx peripheral according to the specified
+ * parameters in the USART_InitStruct .
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @param USART_InitStruct: pointer to a USART_InitTypeDef structure
+ * that contains the configuration information for the specified USART peripheral.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_Init(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, USART_InitTypeDef* USART_InitStruct)
+{
+ uint32_t tmpreg = 0x00, apbclock = 0x00;
+ uint32_t integerdivider = 0x00;
+ uint32_t fractionaldivider = 0x00;
+ uint32_t usartxbase = 0;
+ RCC_ClocksTypeDef RCC_ClocksStatus;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_USART_BAUDRATE(USART_InitStruct->USART_BaudRate));
+ assert_param(IS_USART_WORD_LENGTH(USART_InitStruct->USART_WordLength));
+ assert_param(IS_USART_STOPBITS(USART_InitStruct->USART_StopBits));
+ assert_param(IS_USART_PARITY(USART_InitStruct->USART_Parity));
+ assert_param(IS_USART_MODE(USART_InitStruct->USART_Mode));
+ assert_param(IS_USART_HARDWARE_FLOW_CONTROL(USART_InitStruct->USART_HardwareFlowControl));
+ /* The hardware flow control is available only for USART1, USART2 and USART3 */
+ if (USART_InitStruct->USART_HardwareFlowControl != USART_HardwareFlowControl_None)
+ {
+ assert_param(IS_USART_123_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ }
+
+ usartxbase = (uint32_t)USARTx;
+
+/*---------------------------- USART CR2 Configuration -----------------------*/
+ tmpreg = USARTx->CR2;
+ /* Clear STOP[13:12] bits */
+ tmpreg &= CR2_STOP_CLEAR_Mask;
+ /* Configure the USART Stop Bits, Clock, CPOL, CPHA and LastBit ------------*/
+ /* Set STOP[13:12] bits according to USART_StopBits value */
+ tmpreg |= (uint32_t)USART_InitStruct->USART_StopBits;
+
+ /* Write to USART CR2 */
+ USARTx->CR2 = (uint16_t)tmpreg;
+
+/*---------------------------- USART CR1 Configuration -----------------------*/
+ tmpreg = USARTx->CR1;
+ /* Clear M, PCE, PS, TE and RE bits */
+ tmpreg &= CR1_CLEAR_Mask;
+ /* Configure the USART Word Length, Parity and mode ----------------------- */
+ /* Set the M bits according to USART_WordLength value */
+ /* Set PCE and PS bits according to USART_Parity value */
+ /* Set TE and RE bits according to USART_Mode value */
+ tmpreg |= (uint32_t)USART_InitStruct->USART_WordLength | USART_InitStruct->USART_Parity |
+ USART_InitStruct->USART_Mode;
+ /* Write to USART CR1 */
+ USARTx->CR1 = (uint16_t)tmpreg;
+
+/*---------------------------- USART CR3 Configuration -----------------------*/
+ tmpreg = USARTx->CR3;
+ /* Clear CTSE and RTSE bits */
+ tmpreg &= CR3_CLEAR_Mask;
+ /* Configure the USART HFC -------------------------------------------------*/
+ /* Set CTSE and RTSE bits according to USART_HardwareFlowControl value */
+ tmpreg |= USART_InitStruct->USART_HardwareFlowControl;
+ /* Write to USART CR3 */
+ USARTx->CR3 = (uint16_t)tmpreg;
+
+/*---------------------------- USART BRR Configuration -----------------------*/
+ /* Configure the USART Baud Rate -------------------------------------------*/
+ RCC_GetClocksFreq(&RCC_ClocksStatus);
+ if (usartxbase == USART1_BASE)
+ {
+ apbclock = RCC_ClocksStatus.PCLK2_Frequency;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ apbclock = RCC_ClocksStatus.PCLK1_Frequency;
+ }
+
+ /* Determine the integer part */
+ if ((USARTx->CR1 & CR1_OVER8_Set) != 0)
+ {
+ /* Integer part computing in case Oversampling mode is 8 Samples */
+ integerdivider = ((25 * apbclock) / (2 * (USART_InitStruct->USART_BaudRate)));
+ }
+ else /* if ((USARTx->CR1 & CR1_OVER8_Set) == 0) */
+ {
+ /* Integer part computing in case Oversampling mode is 16 Samples */
+ integerdivider = ((25 * apbclock) / (4 * (USART_InitStruct->USART_BaudRate)));
+ }
+ tmpreg = (integerdivider / 100) << 4;
+
+ /* Determine the fractional part */
+ fractionaldivider = integerdivider - (100 * (tmpreg >> 4));
+
+ /* Implement the fractional part in the register */
+ if ((USARTx->CR1 & CR1_OVER8_Set) != 0)
+ {
+ tmpreg |= ((((fractionaldivider * 8) + 50) / 100)) & ((uint8_t)0x07);
+ }
+ else /* if ((USARTx->CR1 & CR1_OVER8_Set) == 0) */
+ {
+ tmpreg |= ((((fractionaldivider * 16) + 50) / 100)) & ((uint8_t)0x0F);
+ }
+
+ /* Write to USART BRR */
+ USARTx->BRR = (uint16_t)tmpreg;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Fills each USART_InitStruct member with its default value.
+ * @param USART_InitStruct: pointer to a USART_InitTypeDef structure
+ * which will be initialized.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_StructInit(USART_InitTypeDef* USART_InitStruct)
+{
+ /* USART_InitStruct members default value */
+ USART_InitStruct->USART_BaudRate = 9600;
+ USART_InitStruct->USART_WordLength = USART_WordLength_8b;
+ USART_InitStruct->USART_StopBits = USART_StopBits_1;
+ USART_InitStruct->USART_Parity = USART_Parity_No ;
+ USART_InitStruct->USART_Mode = USART_Mode_Rx | USART_Mode_Tx;
+ USART_InitStruct->USART_HardwareFlowControl = USART_HardwareFlowControl_None;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Initializes the USARTx peripheral Clock according to the
+ * specified parameters in the USART_ClockInitStruct .
+ * @param USARTx: where x can be 1, 2, 3 to select the USART peripheral.
+ * @param USART_ClockInitStruct: pointer to a USART_ClockInitTypeDef
+ * structure that contains the configuration information for the specified
+ * USART peripheral.
+ * @note The Smart Card mode is not available for UART4 and UART5.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_ClockInit(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, USART_ClockInitTypeDef* USART_ClockInitStruct)
+{
+ uint32_t tmpreg = 0x00;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_123_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_USART_CLOCK(USART_ClockInitStruct->USART_Clock));
+ assert_param(IS_USART_CPOL(USART_ClockInitStruct->USART_CPOL));
+ assert_param(IS_USART_CPHA(USART_ClockInitStruct->USART_CPHA));
+ assert_param(IS_USART_LASTBIT(USART_ClockInitStruct->USART_LastBit));
+
+/*---------------------------- USART CR2 Configuration -----------------------*/
+ tmpreg = USARTx->CR2;
+ /* Clear CLKEN, CPOL, CPHA and LBCL bits */
+ tmpreg &= CR2_CLOCK_CLEAR_Mask;
+ /* Configure the USART Clock, CPOL, CPHA and LastBit ------------*/
+ /* Set CLKEN bit according to USART_Clock value */
+ /* Set CPOL bit according to USART_CPOL value */
+ /* Set CPHA bit according to USART_CPHA value */
+ /* Set LBCL bit according to USART_LastBit value */
+ tmpreg |= (uint32_t)USART_ClockInitStruct->USART_Clock | USART_ClockInitStruct->USART_CPOL |
+ USART_ClockInitStruct->USART_CPHA | USART_ClockInitStruct->USART_LastBit;
+ /* Write to USART CR2 */
+ USARTx->CR2 = (uint16_t)tmpreg;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Fills each USART_ClockInitStruct member with its default value.
+ * @param USART_ClockInitStruct: pointer to a USART_ClockInitTypeDef
+ * structure which will be initialized.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_ClockStructInit(USART_ClockInitTypeDef* USART_ClockInitStruct)
+{
+ /* USART_ClockInitStruct members default value */
+ USART_ClockInitStruct->USART_Clock = USART_Clock_Disable;
+ USART_ClockInitStruct->USART_CPOL = USART_CPOL_Low;
+ USART_ClockInitStruct->USART_CPHA = USART_CPHA_1Edge;
+ USART_ClockInitStruct->USART_LastBit = USART_LastBit_Disable;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the specified USART peripheral.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the USARTx peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_Cmd(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the selected USART by setting the UE bit in the CR1 register */
+ USARTx->CR1 |= CR1_UE_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the selected USART by clearing the UE bit in the CR1 register */
+ USARTx->CR1 &= CR1_UE_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the specified USART interrupts.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @param USART_IT: specifies the USART interrupt sources to be enabled or disabled.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg USART_IT_CTS: CTS change interrupt (not available for UART4 and UART5)
+ * @arg USART_IT_LBD: LIN Break detection interrupt
+ * @arg USART_IT_TXE: Tansmit Data Register empty interrupt
+ * @arg USART_IT_TC: Transmission complete interrupt
+ * @arg USART_IT_RXNE: Receive Data register not empty interrupt
+ * @arg USART_IT_IDLE: Idle line detection interrupt
+ * @arg USART_IT_PE: Parity Error interrupt
+ * @arg USART_IT_ERR: Error interrupt(Frame error, noise error, overrun error)
+ * @param NewState: new state of the specified USARTx interrupts.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_ITConfig(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, uint16_t USART_IT, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ uint32_t usartreg = 0x00, itpos = 0x00, itmask = 0x00;
+ uint32_t usartxbase = 0x00;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_USART_CONFIG_IT(USART_IT));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ /* The CTS interrupt is not available for UART4 and UART5 */
+ if (USART_IT == USART_IT_CTS)
+ {
+ assert_param(IS_USART_123_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ }
+
+ usartxbase = (uint32_t)USARTx;
+
+ /* Get the USART register index */
+ usartreg = (((uint8_t)USART_IT) >> 0x05);
+
+ /* Get the interrupt position */
+ itpos = USART_IT & IT_Mask;
+ itmask = (((uint32_t)0x01) << itpos);
+
+ if (usartreg == 0x01) /* The IT is in CR1 register */
+ {
+ usartxbase += 0x0C;
+ }
+ else if (usartreg == 0x02) /* The IT is in CR2 register */
+ {
+ usartxbase += 0x10;
+ }
+ else /* The IT is in CR3 register */
+ {
+ usartxbase += 0x14;
+ }
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ *(__IO uint32_t*)usartxbase |= itmask;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ *(__IO uint32_t*)usartxbase &= ~itmask;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the USART’s DMA interface.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @param USART_DMAReq: specifies the DMA request.
+ * This parameter can be any combination of the following values:
+ * @arg USART_DMAReq_Tx: USART DMA transmit request
+ * @arg USART_DMAReq_Rx: USART DMA receive request
+ * @param NewState: new state of the DMA Request sources.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @note The DMA mode is not available for UART5 except in the STM32
+ * High density value line devices(STM32F10X_HD_VL).
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_DMACmd(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, uint16_t USART_DMAReq, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_USART_DMAREQ(USART_DMAReq));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the DMA transfer for selected requests by setting the DMAT and/or
+ DMAR bits in the USART CR3 register */
+ USARTx->CR3 |= USART_DMAReq;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the DMA transfer for selected requests by clearing the DMAT and/or
+ DMAR bits in the USART CR3 register */
+ USARTx->CR3 &= (uint16_t)~USART_DMAReq;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sets the address of the USART node.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @param USART_Address: Indicates the address of the USART node.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_SetAddress(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, uint8_t USART_Address)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ADDRESS(USART_Address));
+
+ /* Clear the USART address */
+ USARTx->CR2 &= CR2_Address_Mask;
+ /* Set the USART address node */
+ USARTx->CR2 |= USART_Address;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Selects the USART WakeUp method.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @param USART_WakeUp: specifies the USART wakeup method.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg USART_WakeUp_IdleLine: WakeUp by an idle line detection
+ * @arg USART_WakeUp_AddressMark: WakeUp by an address mark
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_WakeUpConfig(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, uint16_t USART_WakeUp)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_USART_WAKEUP(USART_WakeUp));
+
+ USARTx->CR1 &= CR1_WAKE_Mask;
+ USARTx->CR1 |= USART_WakeUp;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Determines if the USART is in mute mode or not.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the USART mute mode.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_ReceiverWakeUpCmd(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the USART mute mode by setting the RWU bit in the CR1 register */
+ USARTx->CR1 |= CR1_RWU_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the USART mute mode by clearing the RWU bit in the CR1 register */
+ USARTx->CR1 &= CR1_RWU_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sets the USART LIN Break detection length.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @param USART_LINBreakDetectLength: specifies the LIN break detection length.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg USART_LINBreakDetectLength_10b: 10-bit break detection
+ * @arg USART_LINBreakDetectLength_11b: 11-bit break detection
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_LINBreakDetectLengthConfig(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, uint16_t USART_LINBreakDetectLength)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_USART_LIN_BREAK_DETECT_LENGTH(USART_LINBreakDetectLength));
+
+ USARTx->CR2 &= CR2_LBDL_Mask;
+ USARTx->CR2 |= USART_LINBreakDetectLength;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the USART’s LIN mode.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the USART LIN mode.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_LINCmd(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the LIN mode by setting the LINEN bit in the CR2 register */
+ USARTx->CR2 |= CR2_LINEN_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the LIN mode by clearing the LINEN bit in the CR2 register */
+ USARTx->CR2 &= CR2_LINEN_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Transmits single data through the USARTx peripheral.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @param Data: the data to transmit.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_SendData(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, uint16_t Data)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_USART_DATA(Data));
+
+ /* Transmit Data */
+ USARTx->DR = (Data & (uint16_t)0x01FF);
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Returns the most recent received data by the USARTx peripheral.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @retval The received data.
+ */
+uint16_t USART_ReceiveData(USART_TypeDef* USARTx)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+
+ /* Receive Data */
+ return (uint16_t)(USARTx->DR & (uint16_t)0x01FF);
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Transmits break characters.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_SendBreak(USART_TypeDef* USARTx)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+
+ /* Send break characters */
+ USARTx->CR1 |= CR1_SBK_Set;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sets the specified USART guard time.
+ * @param USARTx: where x can be 1, 2 or 3 to select the USART peripheral.
+ * @param USART_GuardTime: specifies the guard time.
+ * @note The guard time bits are not available for UART4 and UART5.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_SetGuardTime(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, uint8_t USART_GuardTime)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_123_PERIPH(USARTx));
+
+ /* Clear the USART Guard time */
+ USARTx->GTPR &= GTPR_LSB_Mask;
+ /* Set the USART guard time */
+ USARTx->GTPR |= (uint16_t)((uint16_t)USART_GuardTime << 0x08);
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sets the system clock prescaler.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @param USART_Prescaler: specifies the prescaler clock.
+ * @note The function is used for IrDA mode with UART4 and UART5.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_SetPrescaler(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, uint8_t USART_Prescaler)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+
+ /* Clear the USART prescaler */
+ USARTx->GTPR &= GTPR_MSB_Mask;
+ /* Set the USART prescaler */
+ USARTx->GTPR |= USART_Prescaler;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the USART’s Smart Card mode.
+ * @param USARTx: where x can be 1, 2 or 3 to select the USART peripheral.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the Smart Card mode.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @note The Smart Card mode is not available for UART4 and UART5.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_SmartCardCmd(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_123_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the SC mode by setting the SCEN bit in the CR3 register */
+ USARTx->CR3 |= CR3_SCEN_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the SC mode by clearing the SCEN bit in the CR3 register */
+ USARTx->CR3 &= CR3_SCEN_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables NACK transmission.
+ * @param USARTx: where x can be 1, 2 or 3 to select the USART peripheral.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the NACK transmission.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @note The Smart Card mode is not available for UART4 and UART5.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_SmartCardNACKCmd(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_123_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the NACK transmission by setting the NACK bit in the CR3 register */
+ USARTx->CR3 |= CR3_NACK_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the NACK transmission by clearing the NACK bit in the CR3 register */
+ USARTx->CR3 &= CR3_NACK_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the USART’s Half Duplex communication.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the USART Communication.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_HalfDuplexCmd(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the Half-Duplex mode by setting the HDSEL bit in the CR3 register */
+ USARTx->CR3 |= CR3_HDSEL_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the Half-Duplex mode by clearing the HDSEL bit in the CR3 register */
+ USARTx->CR3 &= CR3_HDSEL_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the USART's 8x oversampling mode.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the USART one bit sampling methode.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @note
+ * This function has to be called before calling USART_Init()
+ * function in order to have correct baudrate Divider value.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_OverSampling8Cmd(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the 8x Oversampling mode by setting the OVER8 bit in the CR1 register */
+ USARTx->CR1 |= CR1_OVER8_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the 8x Oversampling mode by clearing the OVER8 bit in the CR1 register */
+ USARTx->CR1 &= CR1_OVER8_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the USART's one bit sampling methode.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the USART one bit sampling methode.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_OneBitMethodCmd(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the one bit method by setting the ONEBITE bit in the CR3 register */
+ USARTx->CR3 |= CR3_ONEBITE_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable tthe one bit method by clearing the ONEBITE bit in the CR3 register */
+ USARTx->CR3 &= CR3_ONEBITE_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Configures the USART’s IrDA interface.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @param USART_IrDAMode: specifies the IrDA mode.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg USART_IrDAMode_LowPower
+ * @arg USART_IrDAMode_Normal
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_IrDAConfig(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, uint16_t USART_IrDAMode)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_USART_IRDA_MODE(USART_IrDAMode));
+
+ USARTx->CR3 &= CR3_IRLP_Mask;
+ USARTx->CR3 |= USART_IrDAMode;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables or disables the USART’s IrDA interface.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @param NewState: new state of the IrDA mode.
+ * This parameter can be: ENABLE or DISABLE.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_IrDACmd(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, FunctionalState NewState)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_FUNCTIONAL_STATE(NewState));
+
+ if (NewState != DISABLE)
+ {
+ /* Enable the IrDA mode by setting the IREN bit in the CR3 register */
+ USARTx->CR3 |= CR3_IREN_Set;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ /* Disable the IrDA mode by clearing the IREN bit in the CR3 register */
+ USARTx->CR3 &= CR3_IREN_Reset;
+ }
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Checks whether the specified USART flag is set or not.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @param USART_FLAG: specifies the flag to check.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg USART_FLAG_CTS: CTS Change flag (not available for UART4 and UART5)
+ * @arg USART_FLAG_LBD: LIN Break detection flag
+ * @arg USART_FLAG_TXE: Transmit data register empty flag
+ * @arg USART_FLAG_TC: Transmission Complete flag
+ * @arg USART_FLAG_RXNE: Receive data register not empty flag
+ * @arg USART_FLAG_IDLE: Idle Line detection flag
+ * @arg USART_FLAG_ORE: OverRun Error flag
+ * @arg USART_FLAG_NE: Noise Error flag
+ * @arg USART_FLAG_FE: Framing Error flag
+ * @arg USART_FLAG_PE: Parity Error flag
+ * @retval The new state of USART_FLAG (SET or RESET).
+ */
+FlagStatus USART_GetFlagStatus(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, uint16_t USART_FLAG)
+{
+ FlagStatus bitstatus = RESET;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_USART_FLAG(USART_FLAG));
+ /* The CTS flag is not available for UART4 and UART5 */
+ if (USART_FLAG == USART_FLAG_CTS)
+ {
+ assert_param(IS_USART_123_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ }
+
+ if ((USARTx->SR & USART_FLAG) != (uint16_t)RESET)
+ {
+ bitstatus = SET;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ bitstatus = RESET;
+ }
+ return bitstatus;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Clears the USARTx's pending flags.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @param USART_FLAG: specifies the flag to clear.
+ * This parameter can be any combination of the following values:
+ * @arg USART_FLAG_CTS: CTS Change flag (not available for UART4 and UART5).
+ * @arg USART_FLAG_LBD: LIN Break detection flag.
+ * @arg USART_FLAG_TC: Transmission Complete flag.
+ * @arg USART_FLAG_RXNE: Receive data register not empty flag.
+ *
+ * @note
+ * - PE (Parity error), FE (Framing error), NE (Noise error), ORE (OverRun
+ * error) and IDLE (Idle line detected) flags are cleared by software
+ * sequence: a read operation to USART_SR register (USART_GetFlagStatus())
+ * followed by a read operation to USART_DR register (USART_ReceiveData()).
+ * - RXNE flag can be also cleared by a read to the USART_DR register
+ * (USART_ReceiveData()).
+ * - TC flag can be also cleared by software sequence: a read operation to
+ * USART_SR register (USART_GetFlagStatus()) followed by a write operation
+ * to USART_DR register (USART_SendData()).
+ * - TXE flag is cleared only by a write to the USART_DR register
+ * (USART_SendData()).
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_ClearFlag(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, uint16_t USART_FLAG)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_USART_CLEAR_FLAG(USART_FLAG));
+ /* The CTS flag is not available for UART4 and UART5 */
+ if ((USART_FLAG & USART_FLAG_CTS) == USART_FLAG_CTS)
+ {
+ assert_param(IS_USART_123_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ }
+
+ USARTx->SR = (uint16_t)~USART_FLAG;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Checks whether the specified USART interrupt has occurred or not.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @param USART_IT: specifies the USART interrupt source to check.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg USART_IT_CTS: CTS change interrupt (not available for UART4 and UART5)
+ * @arg USART_IT_LBD: LIN Break detection interrupt
+ * @arg USART_IT_TXE: Tansmit Data Register empty interrupt
+ * @arg USART_IT_TC: Transmission complete interrupt
+ * @arg USART_IT_RXNE: Receive Data register not empty interrupt
+ * @arg USART_IT_IDLE: Idle line detection interrupt
+ * @arg USART_IT_ORE: OverRun Error interrupt
+ * @arg USART_IT_NE: Noise Error interrupt
+ * @arg USART_IT_FE: Framing Error interrupt
+ * @arg USART_IT_PE: Parity Error interrupt
+ * @retval The new state of USART_IT (SET or RESET).
+ */
+ITStatus USART_GetITStatus(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, uint16_t USART_IT)
+{
+ uint32_t bitpos = 0x00, itmask = 0x00, usartreg = 0x00;
+ ITStatus bitstatus = RESET;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_USART_GET_IT(USART_IT));
+ /* The CTS interrupt is not available for UART4 and UART5 */
+ if (USART_IT == USART_IT_CTS)
+ {
+ assert_param(IS_USART_123_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ }
+
+ /* Get the USART register index */
+ usartreg = (((uint8_t)USART_IT) >> 0x05);
+ /* Get the interrupt position */
+ itmask = USART_IT & IT_Mask;
+ itmask = (uint32_t)0x01 << itmask;
+
+ if (usartreg == 0x01) /* The IT is in CR1 register */
+ {
+ itmask &= USARTx->CR1;
+ }
+ else if (usartreg == 0x02) /* The IT is in CR2 register */
+ {
+ itmask &= USARTx->CR2;
+ }
+ else /* The IT is in CR3 register */
+ {
+ itmask &= USARTx->CR3;
+ }
+
+ bitpos = USART_IT >> 0x08;
+ bitpos = (uint32_t)0x01 << bitpos;
+ bitpos &= USARTx->SR;
+ if ((itmask != (uint16_t)RESET)&&(bitpos != (uint16_t)RESET))
+ {
+ bitstatus = SET;
+ }
+ else
+ {
+ bitstatus = RESET;
+ }
+
+ return bitstatus;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Clears the USARTx’s interrupt pending bits.
+ * @param USARTx: Select the USART or the UART peripheral.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * USART1, USART2, USART3, UART4 or UART5.
+ * @param USART_IT: specifies the interrupt pending bit to clear.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg USART_IT_CTS: CTS change interrupt (not available for UART4 and UART5)
+ * @arg USART_IT_LBD: LIN Break detection interrupt
+ * @arg USART_IT_TC: Transmission complete interrupt.
+ * @arg USART_IT_RXNE: Receive Data register not empty interrupt.
+ *
+ * @note
+ * - PE (Parity error), FE (Framing error), NE (Noise error), ORE (OverRun
+ * error) and IDLE (Idle line detected) pending bits are cleared by
+ * software sequence: a read operation to USART_SR register
+ * (USART_GetITStatus()) followed by a read operation to USART_DR register
+ * (USART_ReceiveData()).
+ * - RXNE pending bit can be also cleared by a read to the USART_DR register
+ * (USART_ReceiveData()).
+ * - TC pending bit can be also cleared by software sequence: a read
+ * operation to USART_SR register (USART_GetITStatus()) followed by a write
+ * operation to USART_DR register (USART_SendData()).
+ * - TXE pending bit is cleared only by a write to the USART_DR register
+ * (USART_SendData()).
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void USART_ClearITPendingBit(USART_TypeDef* USARTx, uint16_t USART_IT)
+{
+ uint16_t bitpos = 0x00, itmask = 0x00;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_USART_ALL_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ assert_param(IS_USART_CLEAR_IT(USART_IT));
+ /* The CTS interrupt is not available for UART4 and UART5 */
+ if (USART_IT == USART_IT_CTS)
+ {
+ assert_param(IS_USART_123_PERIPH(USARTx));
+ }
+
+ bitpos = USART_IT >> 0x08;
+ itmask = ((uint16_t)0x01 << (uint16_t)bitpos);
+ USARTx->SR = (uint16_t)~itmask;
+}
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/******************* (C) COPYRIGHT 2010 STMicroelectronics *****END OF FILE****/
diff --git a/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Libraries/STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver/src/stm32f10x_wwdg.c b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Libraries/STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver/src/stm32f10x_wwdg.c
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..753a710cd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Libraries/STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver/src/stm32f10x_wwdg.c
@@ -0,0 +1,223 @@
+/**
+ ******************************************************************************
+ * @file stm32f10x_wwdg.c
+ * @author MCD Application Team
+ * @version V3.4.0
+ * @date 10/15/2010
+ * @brief This file provides all the WWDG firmware functions.
+ ******************************************************************************
+ * @copy
+ *
+ * THE PRESENT FIRMWARE WHICH IS FOR GUIDANCE ONLY AIMS AT PROVIDING CUSTOMERS
+ * WITH CODING INFORMATION REGARDING THEIR PRODUCTS IN ORDER FOR THEM TO SAVE
+ * TIME. AS A RESULT, STMICROELECTRONICS SHALL NOT BE HELD LIABLE FOR ANY
+ * DIRECT, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES WITH RESPECT TO ANY CLAIMS ARISING
+ * FROM THE CONTENT OF SUCH FIRMWARE AND/OR THE USE MADE BY CUSTOMERS OF THE
+ * CODING INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN IN CONNECTION WITH THEIR PRODUCTS.
+ *
+ *
+ */
+
+/* Includes ------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+#include "stm32f10x_wwdg.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_rcc.h"
+
+/** @addtogroup STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Driver
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup WWDG
+ * @brief WWDG driver modules
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup WWDG_Private_TypesDefinitions
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup WWDG_Private_Defines
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/* ----------- WWDG registers bit address in the alias region ----------- */
+#define WWDG_OFFSET (WWDG_BASE - PERIPH_BASE)
+
+/* Alias word address of EWI bit */
+#define CFR_OFFSET (WWDG_OFFSET + 0x04)
+#define EWI_BitNumber 0x09
+#define CFR_EWI_BB (PERIPH_BB_BASE + (CFR_OFFSET * 32) + (EWI_BitNumber * 4))
+
+/* --------------------- WWDG registers bit mask ------------------------ */
+
+/* CR register bit mask */
+#define CR_WDGA_Set ((uint32_t)0x00000080)
+
+/* CFR register bit mask */
+#define CFR_WDGTB_Mask ((uint32_t)0xFFFFFE7F)
+#define CFR_W_Mask ((uint32_t)0xFFFFFF80)
+#define BIT_Mask ((uint8_t)0x7F)
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup WWDG_Private_Macros
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup WWDG_Private_Variables
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup WWDG_Private_FunctionPrototypes
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/** @defgroup WWDG_Private_Functions
+ * @{
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @brief Deinitializes the WWDG peripheral registers to their default reset values.
+ * @param None
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void WWDG_DeInit(void)
+{
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_WWDG, ENABLE);
+ RCC_APB1PeriphResetCmd(RCC_APB1Periph_WWDG, DISABLE);
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sets the WWDG Prescaler.
+ * @param WWDG_Prescaler: specifies the WWDG Prescaler.
+ * This parameter can be one of the following values:
+ * @arg WWDG_Prescaler_1: WWDG counter clock = (PCLK1/4096)/1
+ * @arg WWDG_Prescaler_2: WWDG counter clock = (PCLK1/4096)/2
+ * @arg WWDG_Prescaler_4: WWDG counter clock = (PCLK1/4096)/4
+ * @arg WWDG_Prescaler_8: WWDG counter clock = (PCLK1/4096)/8
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void WWDG_SetPrescaler(uint32_t WWDG_Prescaler)
+{
+ uint32_t tmpreg = 0;
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_WWDG_PRESCALER(WWDG_Prescaler));
+ /* Clear WDGTB[1:0] bits */
+ tmpreg = WWDG->CFR & CFR_WDGTB_Mask;
+ /* Set WDGTB[1:0] bits according to WWDG_Prescaler value */
+ tmpreg |= WWDG_Prescaler;
+ /* Store the new value */
+ WWDG->CFR = tmpreg;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sets the WWDG window value.
+ * @param WindowValue: specifies the window value to be compared to the downcounter.
+ * This parameter value must be lower than 0x80.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void WWDG_SetWindowValue(uint8_t WindowValue)
+{
+ __IO uint32_t tmpreg = 0;
+
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_WWDG_WINDOW_VALUE(WindowValue));
+ /* Clear W[6:0] bits */
+
+ tmpreg = WWDG->CFR & CFR_W_Mask;
+
+ /* Set W[6:0] bits according to WindowValue value */
+ tmpreg |= WindowValue & (uint32_t) BIT_Mask;
+
+ /* Store the new value */
+ WWDG->CFR = tmpreg;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables the WWDG Early Wakeup interrupt(EWI).
+ * @param None
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void WWDG_EnableIT(void)
+{
+ *(__IO uint32_t *) CFR_EWI_BB = (uint32_t)ENABLE;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Sets the WWDG counter value.
+ * @param Counter: specifies the watchdog counter value.
+ * This parameter must be a number between 0x40 and 0x7F.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void WWDG_SetCounter(uint8_t Counter)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_WWDG_COUNTER(Counter));
+ /* Write to T[6:0] bits to configure the counter value, no need to do
+ a read-modify-write; writing a 0 to WDGA bit does nothing */
+ WWDG->CR = Counter & BIT_Mask;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Enables WWDG and load the counter value.
+ * @param Counter: specifies the watchdog counter value.
+ * This parameter must be a number between 0x40 and 0x7F.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void WWDG_Enable(uint8_t Counter)
+{
+ /* Check the parameters */
+ assert_param(IS_WWDG_COUNTER(Counter));
+ WWDG->CR = CR_WDGA_Set | Counter;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Checks whether the Early Wakeup interrupt flag is set or not.
+ * @param None
+ * @retval The new state of the Early Wakeup interrupt flag (SET or RESET)
+ */
+FlagStatus WWDG_GetFlagStatus(void)
+{
+ return (FlagStatus)(WWDG->SR);
+}
+
+/**
+ * @brief Clears Early Wakeup interrupt flag.
+ * @param None
+ * @retval None
+ */
+void WWDG_ClearFlag(void)
+{
+ WWDG->SR = (uint32_t)RESET;
+}
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/**
+ * @}
+ */
+
+/******************* (C) COPYRIGHT 2010 STMicroelectronics *****END OF FILE****/
diff --git a/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Simple_Demo_Source/FreeRTOSConfig.h b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Simple_Demo_Source/FreeRTOSConfig.h
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..642e53122
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Simple_Demo_Source/FreeRTOSConfig.h
@@ -0,0 +1,142 @@
+/*
+ FreeRTOS V6.1.1 - Copyright (C) 2011 Real Time Engineers Ltd.
+
+ ***************************************************************************
+ * *
+ * If you are: *
+ * *
+ * + New to FreeRTOS, *
+ * + Wanting to learn FreeRTOS or multitasking in general quickly *
+ * + Looking for basic training, *
+ * + Wanting to improve your FreeRTOS skills and productivity *
+ * *
+ * then take a look at the FreeRTOS books - available as PDF or paperback *
+ * *
+ * "Using the FreeRTOS Real Time Kernel - a Practical Guide" *
+ * http://www.FreeRTOS.org/Documentation *
+ * *
+ * A pdf reference manual is also available. Both are usually delivered *
+ * to your inbox within 20 minutes to two hours when purchased between 8am *
+ * and 8pm GMT (although please allow up to 24 hours in case of *
+ * exceptional circumstances). Thank you for your support! *
+ * *
+ ***************************************************************************
+
+ This file is part of the FreeRTOS distribution.
+
+ FreeRTOS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License (version 2) as published by the
+ Free Software Foundation AND MODIFIED BY the FreeRTOS exception.
+ ***NOTE*** The exception to the GPL is included to allow you to distribute
+ a combined work that includes FreeRTOS without being obliged to provide the
+ source code for proprietary components outside of the FreeRTOS kernel.
+ FreeRTOS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT
+ ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License for
+ more details. You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public
+ License and the FreeRTOS license exception along with FreeRTOS; if not it
+ can be viewed here: http://www.freertos.org/a00114.html and also obtained
+ by writing to Richard Barry, contact details for whom are available on the
+ FreeRTOS WEB site.
+
+ 1 tab == 4 spaces!
+
+ http://www.FreeRTOS.org - Documentation, latest information, license and
+ contact details.
+
+ http://www.SafeRTOS.com - A version that is certified for use in safety
+ critical systems.
+
+ http://www.OpenRTOS.com - Commercial support, development, porting,
+ licensing and training services.
+*/
+
+
+/* The following #error directive is to remind users that a batch file must be
+ * executed prior to this project being built. The batch file *cannot* be
+ * executed from within CCS4! Once it has been executed, re-open or refresh
+ * the CCS4 project and remove the #error line below.
+ */
+//#error Ensure CreateProjectDirectoryStructure.bat has been executed before building. See comment immediately above.
+
+
+#ifndef FREERTOS_CONFIG_H
+#define FREERTOS_CONFIG_H
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------
+ * Application specific definitions.
+ *
+ * These definitions should be adjusted for your particular hardware and
+ * application requirements.
+ *
+ * THESE PARAMETERS ARE DESCRIBED WITHIN THE 'CONFIGURATION' SECTION OF THE
+ * FreeRTOS API DOCUMENTATION AVAILABLE ON THE FreeRTOS.org WEB SITE.
+ *
+ * See http://www.freertos.org/a00110.html.
+ *----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+#define configUSE_PREEMPTION 1
+#define configUSE_IDLE_HOOK 1
+#define configUSE_TICK_HOOK 0
+#define configCPU_CLOCK_HZ ( 24000000UL )
+#define configTICK_RATE_HZ ( ( portTickType ) 1000 )
+#define configMAX_PRIORITIES ( ( unsigned portBASE_TYPE ) 5 )
+#define configMINIMAL_STACK_SIZE ( ( unsigned short ) 70 )
+#define configTOTAL_HEAP_SIZE ( ( size_t ) ( 7 * 1024 ) )
+#define configMAX_TASK_NAME_LEN ( 10 )
+#define configUSE_TRACE_FACILITY 0
+#define configUSE_16_BIT_TICKS 0
+#define configIDLE_SHOULD_YIELD 1
+#define configUSE_MUTEXES 1
+#define configQUEUE_REGISTRY_SIZE 0
+#define configGENERATE_RUN_TIME_STATS 0
+#define configCHECK_FOR_STACK_OVERFLOW 2
+#define configUSE_RECURSIVE_MUTEXES 0
+#define configUSE_MALLOC_FAILED_HOOK 1
+#define configUSE_APPLICATION_TASK_TAG 0
+#define configUSE_COUNTING_SEMAPHORES 0
+
+/* Co-routine definitions. */
+#define configUSE_CO_ROUTINES 0
+#define configMAX_CO_ROUTINE_PRIORITIES ( 2 )
+
+/* Software timer definitions. */
+#define configUSE_TIMERS 1
+#define configTIMER_TASK_PRIORITY ( 3 )
+#define configTIMER_QUEUE_LENGTH 5
+#define configTIMER_TASK_STACK_DEPTH ( configMINIMAL_STACK_SIZE )
+
+/* Set the following definitions to 1 to include the API function, or zero
+to exclude the API function. */
+#define INCLUDE_vTaskPrioritySet 1
+#define INCLUDE_uxTaskPriorityGet 1
+#define INCLUDE_vTaskDelete 1
+#define INCLUDE_vTaskCleanUpResources 1
+#define INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend 1
+#define INCLUDE_vTaskDelayUntil 1
+#define INCLUDE_vTaskDelay 1
+
+/* Use the system definition, if there is one */
+#ifdef __NVIC_PRIO_BITS
+ #define configPRIO_BITS __NVIC_PRIO_BITS
+#else
+ #define configPRIO_BITS 4 /* 15 priority levels */
+#endif
+
+#define configLIBRARY_LOWEST_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY 15
+#define configLIBRARY_MAX_SYSCALL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY 5
+
+/* The lowest priority. */
+#define configKERNEL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY ( configLIBRARY_LOWEST_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY << (8 - configPRIO_BITS) )
+/* Priority 5, or 160 as only the top three bits are implemented. */
+#define configMAX_SYSCALL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY ( configLIBRARY_MAX_SYSCALL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY << (8 - configPRIO_BITS) )
+
+#define configASSERT( x ) if( ( x ) == 0 ) { taskDISABLE_INTERRUPTS(); for( ;; ); }
+
+#define vPortSVCHandler SVC_Handler
+#define xPortPendSVHandler PendSV_Handler
+#define vPortSVCHandler SVC_Handler
+#define xPortSysTickHandler SysTick_Handler
+
+#endif /* FREERTOS_CONFIG_H */
+
diff --git a/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Simple_Demo_Source/main.c b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Simple_Demo_Source/main.c
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..c6659e4de
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Simple_Demo_Source/main.c
@@ -0,0 +1,342 @@
+/*
+ FreeRTOS V6.1.1 - Copyright (C) 2011 Real Time Engineers Ltd.
+
+ ***************************************************************************
+ * *
+ * If you are: *
+ * *
+ * + New to FreeRTOS, *
+ * + Wanting to learn FreeRTOS or multitasking in general quickly *
+ * + Looking for basic training, *
+ * + Wanting to improve your FreeRTOS skills and productivity *
+ * *
+ * then take a look at the FreeRTOS books - available as PDF or paperback *
+ * *
+ * "Using the FreeRTOS Real Time Kernel - a Practical Guide" *
+ * http://www.FreeRTOS.org/Documentation *
+ * *
+ * A pdf reference manual is also available. Both are usually delivered *
+ * to your inbox within 20 minutes to two hours when purchased between 8am *
+ * and 8pm GMT (although please allow up to 24 hours in case of *
+ * exceptional circumstances). Thank you for your support! *
+ * *
+ ***************************************************************************
+
+ This file is part of the FreeRTOS distribution.
+
+ FreeRTOS is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
+ the terms of the GNU General Public License (version 2) as published by the
+ Free Software Foundation AND MODIFIED BY the FreeRTOS exception.
+ ***NOTE*** The exception to the GPL is included to allow you to distribute
+ a combined work that includes FreeRTOS without being obliged to provide the
+ source code for proprietary components outside of the FreeRTOS kernel.
+ FreeRTOS is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT
+ ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
+ FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License for
+ more details. You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public
+ License and the FreeRTOS license exception along with FreeRTOS; if not it
+ can be viewed here: http://www.freertos.org/a00114.html and also obtained
+ by writing to Richard Barry, contact details for whom are available on the
+ FreeRTOS WEB site.
+
+ 1 tab == 4 spaces!
+
+ http://www.FreeRTOS.org - Documentation, latest information, license and
+ contact details.
+
+ http://www.SafeRTOS.com - A version that is certified for use in safety
+ critical systems.
+
+ http://www.OpenRTOS.com - Commercial support, development, porting,
+ licensing and training services.
+*/
+
+/*
+This simple demo project runs on the STM32 Discovery board, which is
+populated with an STM32F100RB Cortex-M3 microcontroller. The discovery board
+makes an ideal low cost evaluation platform, but the 8K of RAM provided on the
+STM32F100RB does not allow the simple application to demonstrate all of all the
+FreeRTOS kernel features. Therefore, this simple demo only actively
+demonstrates task, queue, timer and interrupt functionality. In addition, the
+demo is configured to include malloc failure, idle and stack overflow hook
+functions.
+
+The idle hook function:
+The idle hook function queries the amount of FreeRTOS heap space that is
+remaining (see vApplicationIdleHook() defined in this file). The demo
+application is configured use 7K or the available 8K of RAM as the FreeRTOS heap.
+Memory is only allocated from this heap during initialisation, and this demo
+only actually uses 1.6K bytes of the configured 7K available - leaving 5.4K
+bytes of heap space unallocated.
+
+The main() Function:
+main() creates one software timer, one queue, and two tasks. It then starts the
+scheduler.
+
+The Queue Send Task:
+The queue send task is implemented by the prvQueueSendTask() function in this
+file. prvQueueSendTask() sits in a loop that causes it to repeatedly block for
+200 milliseconds, before sending the value 100 to the queue that was created
+within main(). Once the value is sent, the task loops back around to block for
+another 200 milliseconds.
+
+The Queue Receive Task:
+The queue receive task is implemented by the prvQueueReceiveTask() function
+in this file. prvQueueReceiveTask() sits in a loop that causes repeatedly
+attempt to read data from the queue that was created within main(). When data
+is received, the task checks the value of the data, and if the value equals
+the expected 100, toggles the green LED. The 'block time' parameter passed to
+the queue receive function specifies that the task should be held in the Blocked
+state indefinitely to wait for data to be available on the queue. The queue
+receive task will only leave the Blocked state when the queue send task writes
+to the queue. As the queue send task writes to the queue every 200
+milliseconds, the queue receive task leaves the Blocked state every 200
+milliseconds, and therefore toggles the green LED every 200 milliseconds.
+
+The LED Software Timer and the Button Interrupt:
+The user button B1 is configured to generate an interrupt each time it is
+pressed. The interrupt service routine switches the red LED on, and resets the
+LED software timer. The LED timer has a 5000 millisecond (5 second) period, and
+uses a callback function that is defined to just turn the red LED off.
+Therefore, pressing the user button will turn the red LED on, and the LED will
+remain on until a full five seconds pass without the button being pressed.
+*/
+
+
+/* Kernel includes. */
+#include "FreeRTOS.h"
+#include "task.h"
+#include "queue.h"
+#include "timers.h"
+
+/* STM32 Library includes. */
+#include "stm32f10x.h"
+#include "STM32vldiscovery.h"
+
+/* Priorities at which the tasks are created. */
+#define mainQUEUE_RECEIVE_TASK_PRIORITY ( tskIDLE_PRIORITY + 2 )
+#define mainQUEUE_SEND_TASK_PRIORITY ( tskIDLE_PRIORITY + 1 )
+
+/* The rate at which data is sent to the queue, specified in milliseconds, and
+converted to ticks using the portTICK_RATE_MS constant. */
+#define mainQUEUE_SEND_FREQUENCY_MS ( 200 / portTICK_RATE_MS )
+
+/* The number of items the queue can hold. This is 1 as the receive task
+will remove items as they are added, meaning the send task should always find
+the queue empty. */
+#define mainQUEUE_LENGTH ( 1 )
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/*
+ * Setup the NVIC, LED outputs, and button inputs.
+ */
+static void prvSetupHardware( void );
+
+/*
+ * The tasks as described in the comments at the top of this file.
+ */
+static void prvQueueReceiveTask( void *pvParameters );
+static void prvQueueSendTask( void *pvParameters );
+
+/*
+ * The LED timer callback function. This does nothing but switch the red LED
+ * off.
+ */
+static void vLEDTimerCallback( xTimerHandle xTimer );
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/* The queue used by both tasks. */
+static xQueueHandle xQueue = NULL;
+
+/* The LED software timer. This uses vLEDTimerCallback() as its callback
+ * function.
+ */
+static xTimerHandle xLEDTimer = NULL;
+
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+int main(void)
+{
+ /* Configure the NVIC, LED outputs and button inputs. */
+ prvSetupHardware();
+
+ /* Create the queue. */
+ xQueue = xQueueCreate( mainQUEUE_LENGTH, sizeof( unsigned long ) );
+
+ if( xQueue != NULL )
+ {
+ /* Start the two tasks as described in the comments at the top of this
+ file. */
+ xTaskCreate( prvQueueReceiveTask, ( signed char * ) "Rx", configMINIMAL_STACK_SIZE, NULL, mainQUEUE_RECEIVE_TASK_PRIORITY, NULL );
+ xTaskCreate( prvQueueSendTask, ( signed char * ) "TX", configMINIMAL_STACK_SIZE, NULL, mainQUEUE_SEND_TASK_PRIORITY, NULL );
+
+ /* Create the software timer that is responsible for turning off the LED
+ if the button is not pushed within 5000ms, as described at the top of
+ this file. */
+ xLEDTimer = xTimerCreate( ( const signed char * ) "LEDTimer", /* A text name, purely to help debugging. */
+ ( 5000 / portTICK_RATE_MS ), /* The timer period, in this case 5000ms (5s). */
+ pdFALSE, /* This is a one shot timer, so xAutoReload is set to pdFALSE. */
+ ( void * ) 0, /* The ID is not used, so can be set to anything. */
+ vLEDTimerCallback /* The callback function that switches the LED off. */
+ );
+
+ /* Start the tasks and timer running. */
+ vTaskStartScheduler();
+ }
+
+ /* If all is well, the scheduler will now be running, and the following line
+ will never be reached. If the following line does execute, then there was
+ insufficient FreeRTOS heap memory available for the idle and/or timer tasks
+ to be created. See the memory management section on the FreeRTOS web site
+ for more details. */
+ for( ;; );
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void vLEDTimerCallback( xTimerHandle xTimer )
+{
+ /* The timer has expired - so no button pushes have occurred in the last
+ five seconds - turn the LED off. NOTE - accessing the LED port should use
+ a critical section because it is accessed from multiple tasks, and the
+ button interrupt - in this trivial case, for simplicity, the critical
+ section is omitted. */
+ STM32vldiscovery_LEDOff( LED4 );
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+/* The ISR executed when the user button is pushed. */
+void EXTI0_IRQHandler( void )
+{
+portBASE_TYPE xHigherPriorityTaskWoken = pdFALSE;
+
+ /* The button was pushed, so ensure the LED is on before resetting the
+ LED timer. The LED timer will turn the LED off if the button is not
+ pushed within 5000ms. */
+ STM32vldiscovery_LEDOn( LED4 );
+
+ /* This interrupt safe FreeRTOS function can be called from this interrupt
+ because the interrupt priority is below the
+ configMAX_SYSCALL_INTERRUPT_PRIORITY setting in FreeRTOSConfig.h. */
+ xTimerResetFromISR( xLEDTimer, &xHigherPriorityTaskWoken );
+
+ /* Clear the interrupt before leaving. */
+ EXTI_ClearITPendingBit( EXTI_Line0 );
+
+ /* If calling xTimerResetFromISR() caused a task (in this case the timer
+ service/daemon task) to unblock, and the unblocked task has a priority
+ higher than or equal to the task that was interrupted, then
+ xHigherPriorityTaskWoken will now be set to pdTRUE, and calling
+ portEND_SWITCHING_ISR() will ensure the unblocked task runs next. */
+ portEND_SWITCHING_ISR( xHigherPriorityTaskWoken );
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void prvQueueSendTask( void *pvParameters )
+{
+portTickType xNextWakeTime;
+const unsigned long ulValueToSend = 100UL;
+
+ /* Initialise xNextWakeTime - this only needs to be done once. */
+ xNextWakeTime = xTaskGetTickCount();
+
+ for( ;; )
+ {
+ /* Place this task in the blocked state until it is time to run again.
+ The block time is specified in ticks, the constant used converts ticks
+ to ms. While in the Blocked state this task will not consume any CPU
+ time. */
+ vTaskDelayUntil( &xNextWakeTime, mainQUEUE_SEND_FREQUENCY_MS );
+
+ /* Send to the queue - causing the queue receive task to unblock and
+ toggle an LED. 0 is used as the block time so the sending operation
+ will not block - it shouldn't need to block as the queue should always
+ be empty at this point in the code. */
+ xQueueSend( xQueue, &ulValueToSend, 0 );
+ }
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void prvQueueReceiveTask( void *pvParameters )
+{
+unsigned long ulReceivedValue;
+
+ for( ;; )
+ {
+ /* Wait until something arrives in the queue - this task will block
+ indefinitely provided INCLUDE_vTaskSuspend is set to 1 in
+ FreeRTOSConfig.h. */
+ xQueueReceive( xQueue, &ulReceivedValue, portMAX_DELAY );
+
+ /* To get here something must have been received from the queue, but
+ is it the expected value? If it is, toggle the green LED. */
+ if( ulReceivedValue == 100UL )
+ {
+ /* NOTE - accessing the LED port should use a critical section
+ because it is accessed from multiple tasks, and the button interrupt
+ - in this trivial case, for simplicity, the critical section is
+ omitted. */
+ STM32vldiscovery_LEDToggle( LED3 );
+ }
+ }
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+static void prvSetupHardware( void )
+{
+ /* Ensure that all 4 interrupt priority bits are used as the pre-emption
+ priority. */
+ NVIC_PriorityGroupConfig( NVIC_PriorityGroup_4 );
+
+ /* Set up the LED outputs and the button inputs. */
+ STM32vldiscovery_LEDInit( LED3 );
+ STM32vldiscovery_LEDInit( LED4 );
+ STM32vldiscovery_PBInit( BUTTON_USER, BUTTON_MODE_EXTI );
+
+ /* Start with the LEDs off. */
+ STM32vldiscovery_LEDOff( LED3 );
+ STM32vldiscovery_LEDOff( LED4 );
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vApplicationMallocFailedHook( void )
+{
+ /* Called if a call to pvPortMalloc() fails because there is insufficient
+ free memory available in the FreeRTOS heap. pvPortMalloc() is called
+ internally by FreeRTOS API functions that create tasks, queues, software
+ timers, and semaphores. The size of the FreeRTOS heap is set by the
+ configTOTAL_HEAP_SIZE configuration constant in FreeRTOSConfig.h. */
+ for( ;; );
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vApplicationStackOverflowHook( xTaskHandle *pxTask, signed char *pcTaskName )
+{
+ ( void ) pcTaskName;
+ ( void ) pxTask;
+
+ /* Run time stack overflow checking is performed if
+ configconfigCHECK_FOR_STACK_OVERFLOW is defined to 1 or 2. This hook
+ function is called if a stack overflow is detected. */
+ for( ;; );
+}
+/*-----------------------------------------------------------*/
+
+void vApplicationIdleHook( void )
+{
+volatile size_t xFreeStackSpace;
+
+ /* This function is called on each cycle of the idle task. In this case it
+ does nothing useful, other than report the amout of FreeRTOS heap that
+ remains unallocated. */
+ xFreeStackSpace = xPortGetFreeHeapSize();
+
+ if( xFreeStackSpace > 100 )
+ {
+ /* By now, the kernel has allocated everything it is going to, so
+ if there is a lot of heap remaining unallocated then
+ the value of configTOTAL_HEAP_SIZE in FreeRTOSConfig.h can be
+ reduced accordingly. */
+ }
+}
diff --git a/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Simple_Demo_Source/stm32f10x_conf.h b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Simple_Demo_Source/stm32f10x_conf.h
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..19049ed98
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Simple_Demo_Source/stm32f10x_conf.h
@@ -0,0 +1,77 @@
+/**
+ ******************************************************************************
+ * @file Project/STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Template/stm32f10x_conf.h
+ * @author MCD Application Team
+ * @version V3.4.0
+ * @date 10/15/2010
+ * @brief Library configuration file.
+ ******************************************************************************
+ * @copy
+ *
+ * THE PRESENT FIRMWARE WHICH IS FOR GUIDANCE ONLY AIMS AT PROVIDING CUSTOMERS
+ * WITH CODING INFORMATION REGARDING THEIR PRODUCTS IN ORDER FOR THEM TO SAVE
+ * TIME. AS A RESULT, STMICROELECTRONICS SHALL NOT BE HELD LIABLE FOR ANY
+ * DIRECT, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES WITH RESPECT TO ANY CLAIMS ARISING
+ * FROM THE CONTENT OF SUCH FIRMWARE AND/OR THE USE MADE BY CUSTOMERS OF THE
+ * CODING INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN IN CONNECTION WITH THEIR PRODUCTS.
+ *
+ *
+ */
+
+/* Define to prevent recursive inclusion -------------------------------------*/
+#ifndef __STM32F10x_CONF_H
+#define __STM32F10x_CONF_H
+
+/* Includes ------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+/* Uncomment the line below to enable peripheral header file inclusion */
+#include "stm32f10x_adc.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_bkp.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_can.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_cec.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_crc.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_dac.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_dbgmcu.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_dma.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_exti.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_flash.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_fsmc.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_gpio.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_i2c.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_iwdg.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_pwr.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_rcc.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_rtc.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_sdio.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_spi.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_tim.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_usart.h"
+#include "stm32f10x_wwdg.h"
+#include "misc.h" /* High level functions for NVIC and SysTick (add-on to CMSIS functions) */
+
+/* Exported types ------------------------------------------------------------*/
+/* Exported constants --------------------------------------------------------*/
+/* Uncomment the line below to expanse the "assert_param" macro in the
+ Standard Peripheral Library drivers code */
+/* #define USE_FULL_ASSERT 1 */
+
+/* Exported macro ------------------------------------------------------------*/
+#ifdef USE_FULL_ASSERT
+
+/**
+ * @brief The assert_param macro is used for function's parameters check.
+ * @param expr: If expr is false, it calls assert_failed function
+ * which reports the name of the source file and the source
+ * line number of the call that failed.
+ * If expr is true, it returns no value.
+ * @retval None
+ */
+ #define assert_param(expr) ((expr) ? (void)0 : assert_failed((uint8_t *)__FILE__, __LINE__))
+/* Exported functions ------------------------------------------------------- */
+ void assert_failed(uint8_t* file, uint32_t line);
+#else
+ #define assert_param(expr) ((void)0)
+#endif /* USE_FULL_ASSERT */
+
+#endif /* __STM32F10x_CONF_H */
+
+/******************* (C) COPYRIGHT 2010 STMicroelectronics *****END OF FILE****/
diff --git a/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Simple_Demo_Source/stm32f10x_it.c b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Simple_Demo_Source/stm32f10x_it.c
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..02863aa29
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Simple_Demo_Source/stm32f10x_it.c
@@ -0,0 +1,159 @@
+/**
+ ******************************************************************************
+ * @file Project/STM32F10x_StdPeriph_Template/stm32f10x_it.c
+ * @author MCD Application Team
+ * @version V3.4.0
+ * @date 10/15/2010
+ * @brief Main Interrupt Service Routines.
+ * This file provides template for all exceptions handler and
+ * peripherals interrupt service routine.
+ ******************************************************************************
+ * @copy
+ *
+ * THE PRESENT FIRMWARE WHICH IS FOR GUIDANCE ONLY AIMS AT PROVIDING CUSTOMERS
+ * WITH CODING INFORMATION REGARDING THEIR PRODUCTS IN ORDER FOR THEM TO SAVE
+ * TIME. AS A RESULT, STMICROELECTRONICS SHALL NOT BE HELD LIABLE FOR ANY
+ * DIRECT, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES WITH RESPECT TO ANY CLAIMS ARISING
+ * FROM THE CONTENT OF SUCH FIRMWARE AND/OR THE USE MADE BY CUSTOMERS OF THE
+ * CODING INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN IN CONNECTION WITH THEIR PRODUCTS.
+ *
+ *
+ */
+
+/* Define to prevent recursive inclusion -------------------------------------*/
+#ifndef __STM32F10x_IT_H
+#define __STM32F10x_IT_H
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+ extern "C" {
+#endif
+
+/* Includes ------------------------------------------------------------------*/
+#include "stm32f10x.h"
+
+/* Exported types ------------------------------------------------------------*/
+/* Exported constants --------------------------------------------------------*/
+/* Exported macro ------------------------------------------------------------*/
+/* Exported functions ------------------------------------------------------- */
+
+void NMI_Handler(void);
+void HardFault_Handler(void);
+void MemManage_Handler(void);
+void BusFault_Handler(void);
+void UsageFault_Handler(void);
+void SVC_Handler(void);
+void DebugMon_Handler(void);
+void PendSV_Handler(void);
+void SysTick_Handler(void);
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+}
+#endif
+
+#endif /* __STM32F10x_IT_H */
+
+/******************* (C) COPYRIGHT 2010 STMicroelectronics *****END OF FILE****/
diff --git a/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Simple_Demo_Source/system_stm32f10x.c b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Simple_Demo_Source/system_stm32f10x.c
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..50af0dc3f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Demo/CORTEX_STM32F100_Atollic/Simple_Demo_Source/system_stm32f10x.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1033 @@
+/**
+ ******************************************************************************
+ * @file system_stm32f10x.c
+ * @author MCD Application Team
+ * @version V3.4.0
+ * @date 10/15/2010
+ * @brief CMSIS Cortex-M3 Device Peripheral Access Layer System Source File.
+ ******************************************************************************
+ *
+ * THE PRESENT FIRMWARE WHICH IS FOR GUIDANCE ONLY AIMS AT PROVIDING CUSTOMERS
+ * WITH CODING INFORMATION REGARDING THEIR PRODUCTS IN ORDER FOR THEM TO SAVE
+ * TIME. AS A RESULT, STMICROELECTRONICS SHALL NOT BE HELD LIABLE FOR ANY
+ * DIRECT, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES WITH RESPECT TO ANY CLAIMS ARISING
+ * FROM THE CONTENT OF SUCH FIRMWARE AND/OR THE USE MADE BY CUSTOMERS OF THE
+ * CODING INFORMATION CONTAINED HEREIN IN CONNECTION WITH THEIR PRODUCTS.
+ *
+ *